*** empty log message ***
[bpt/emacs.git] / etc / NEWS
CommitLineData
c67de8ba 1GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
73a6a972
SM
2Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
a933dad1
DL
4See the end for copying conditions.
5
6Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
3787e12e 7For older news, see the file ONEWS
5a2c89c3
JL
8You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
9`view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
a933dad1 10
ad8d610b
KS
11Temporary note:
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
14When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
1a0b9ae4 15so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
ad8d610b 16
05197f40 17\f
bf247b6e 18* Installation Changes in Emacs 22.1
76fb24bb 19
1ebd4f78
JB
20** Emacs includes now support for loading image libraries on demand.
21(Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
22the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
23setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
24
bc83b22b 25---
b687047c
WL
26** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the following
27 languages: Brasilian, Bulgarian, Chinese (both with simplified and
28 traditional characters), French, and Italian. Type `C-u C-h t' to
29 choose one of them in case your language setup doesn't automatically
30 select the right one.
bc83b22b 31
a775dff4 32---
0571f2d8 33** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
7bea57c9
DL
34when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
35provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
0571f2d8 36
2b6bb1f2 37---
d2a53bb7
PJ
38** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
39
a775dff4 40---
4208da83
SM
41** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with elisp code.
42
2b6bb1f2 43---
76fb24bb
PJ
44** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
45`--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
46installed programs.
47
2b6bb1f2 48---
81f755ae 49** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
672ab90b
CW
50scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
51place for game scores to be stored. This may be controlled by the
52configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
53to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
5167cfda
CW
54to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
55in each user's home directory.
81f755ae 56
cd7d2d9e
EZ
57---
58** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
59You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
60Emacs with Leim.
61
4e5cdb4f
KS
62+++
63** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
64
65The ELisp reference manual in Info format is built as part of the
66Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
67Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
68accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
69
70---
71** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
72the distribution.
73
74This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
75together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
76item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
77(Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
78
a775dff4 79---
c60ee5e7
JB
80** Support for Cygwin was added.
81
a17b3614 82---
1096bcc0
GM
83** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
84
84913e36
EZ
85---
86** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
87
82e119fb
EZ
88---
89** Support for MacOS X was added.
90See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
91
2b6bb1f2 92---
3fa4ac47 93** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
16927a56 94
a775dff4 95---
561a8f98
YM
96** Mac OS 9 port now uses the Carbon API by default. You can also
97create non-Carbon build by specifying `NonCarbon' as a target. See
98the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
99
d2d70cb6 100---
4e5cdb4f
KS
101** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
102
103---
d7107586
SM
104** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
105types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
4e5cdb4f
KS
106
107\f
bf247b6e 108* Changes in Emacs 22.1
d2d70cb6 109
a775dff4 110+++
bc8113ba
RS
111** The commands copy-file, rename-file, make-symbolic-link and
112add-name-to-file, when given a directory as the "new name" argument,
113convert it to a file name by merging in the within-directory part of
114the existing file's name. (This is the same convention that shell
115commands cp, mv, and ln follow.) Thus, M-x copy-file RET ~/foo RET
116/tmp RET copies ~/foo to /tmp/foo.
117
a775dff4 118+++
c7bd5d57
RS
119** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
120M-o M-o requests refontification.
121
a775dff4 122+++
c7bd5d57
RS
123** M-g is now a prefix key. M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
124
a775dff4 125+++
c7bd5d57
RS
126** font-lock-lines-before specifies a number of lines before the
127current line that should be refontified when you change the buffer.
128The default value is 1.
129
a775dff4 130+++
bb96021a
RS
131** C-u M-x goto-line now switches to the most recent previous buffer,
132and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
133
134When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
135point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
136
a775dff4
RS
137---
138** Emacs now responds to mouse-clicks on the mode-line, header-line and
139display margin, when run in an xterm.
d0d0434f 140
a775dff4 141+++
444919be
RS
142** M-SPC (just-one-space) when given a numeric argument N
143converts whitespace around point to N spaces.
144
a775dff4 145+++
8ab2c119
KS
146** Control characters and escape glyphs are now shown in the new
147escape-glyph face.
148
149** Non-breaking space and hyphens are now prefixed with an escape
150character, unless the new user variable `show-nonbreak-escape' is set
151to nil.
152
3ac99ced
EZ
153---
154** The type-break package now allows `type-break-file-name' to be nil
155and if so, doesn't store any data across sessions. This is handy if
156you don't want the .type-break file in your home directory or are
157annoyed by the need for interaction when you kill Emacs.
158
a775dff4 159---
73a6a972 160** display-battery has been replaced by display-battery-mode.
8ab2c119 161
a775dff4 162---
1db7dd46
RS
163** calculator.el now has radix grouping mode, which is available when
164`calculator-output-radix' is non-nil. In this mode a separator
165character is used every few digits, making it easier to see byte
166boundries etc. For more info, see the documentation of the variable
167`calculator-radix-grouping-mode'.
56011a8c 168
4e07258f 169+++
414ac1a3 170** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
c44edf72 171
414ac1a3
RS
172Traditionally, Emacs uses a Mouse-1 click to set point and a Mouse-2
173click to follow a link, whereas most other applications use a Mouse-1
c44edf72 174click for both purposes, depending on whether you click outside or
4e07258f
RS
175inside a link. Now the behavior of a Mouse-1 click has been changed
176to match this context-sentitive dual behavior.
c44edf72 177
414ac1a3 178Depending on the current mode, a Mouse-2 click in Emacs may do much
4e07258f 179more than just follow a link, so the new Mouse-1 behavior is only
c44edf72 180activated for modes which explicitly mark a clickable text as a "link"
4e07258f 181(see the new function `mouse-on-link-p' for details). The Lisp
bf247b6e 182packages that are included in release 22.1 have been adapted to do
c44edf72
KS
183this, but external packages may not yet support this. However, there
184is no risk in using such packages, as the worst thing that could
4e07258f 185happen is that you get the original Mouse-1 behavior when you click
c44edf72
KS
186on a link, which typically means that you set point where you click.
187
414ac1a3
RS
188If you want to get the original Mouse-1 action also inside a link, you
189just need to press the Mouse-1 button a little longer than a normal
190click (i.e. press and hold the Mouse-1 button for half a second before
c44edf72
KS
191you release it).
192
414ac1a3 193Dragging the Mouse-1 inside a link still performs the original
c44edf72
KS
194drag-mouse-1 action, typically copy the text.
195
c6f4488c
KS
196You can customize the new Mouse-1 behavior via the new user options
197`mouse-1-click-follows-link' and `mouse-1-click-in-non-selected-windows'.
c44edf72 198
1db7dd46
RS
199+++
200** require-final-newline now has two new possible values:
201
202`visit' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's needed
203when visiting the file.
204
205`visit-save' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's
206needed when visiting the file, and also add a newline if it's needed
207when saving the file.
208
209+++
210** The new option mode-require-final-newline controls how certain
211major modes enable require-final-newline. Any major mode that's
212designed for a kind of file that should normally end in a newline
213sets require-final-newline based on mode-require-final-newline.
214So you can customize mode-require-final-newline to control what these
215modes do.
216
414ac1a3
RS
217+++
218** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
d4d66807
LT
219(beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
220you about it.
414ac1a3 221
a775dff4 222+++
18819b0f
RS
223** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
224
4ac3afb9
EZ
225** In Outline mode, hide-body no longer hides lines at the top
226of the file that precede the first header line.
227
5086e75d
LT
228+++
229** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
230by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
231and `C-c C-r'.
232
4d894c98
RS
233+++
234** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
235suffix are from every line before processing all the lines.
236
7d01236c 237+++
61b73aa4
LT
238** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
239in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
240
2ee3b79e
RS
241** global-whitespace-mode is a new alias for whitespace-global-mode.
242
dd0a3ea3
LT
243+++
244** There are now two new regular expression operators, \_< and \_>,
245for matching the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
246non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
247specified by the syntax table.
248
8758f42e
JB
249** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
250You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
251existing values. For example:
252
253 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
254
255will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
256irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
257
a775dff4 258---
ffbec9ba
DN
259** The terminal emulation code in term.el has been improved, it can
260run most curses applications now.
261
3fc3e0a6
JL
262** New features in evaluation commands
263
a1bcf785 264+++
3fc3e0a6
JL
265*** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
266the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
267
a775dff4 268+++
3fc3e0a6
JL
269*** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
270in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
271by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
272function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
273`eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
a7ab1711 274
a775dff4 275---
9254ee5e
KH
276** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
277characters.
278
a775dff4 279+++
64a0fd20
KH
280** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
281in the current input method to input a character at point.
44251fad 282
a775dff4 283+++
f0529fe1
JB
284** Convenient commands to switch buffers in a cyclic order are C-x <left>
285(prev-buffer) and C-x <right> (next-buffer).
286
a775dff4 287---
f0529fe1
JB
288** Commands winner-redo and winner-undo, from winner.el, are now bound to
289C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an incompatible change.
290
11d7bca4 291** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
85f6be54 292arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
bfd40f00
JB
293default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
294`help-default-arg-highlight'.
f0529fe1 295
21fb7588 296---
0dbc1dd0
LT
297** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
298option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
299except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
300controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
8248b4ad
LT
301overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
302
303The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
304support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
305
306`comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
d1b2b8cc 307read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
8248b4ad
LT
308lines, including any prompts.
309
310`comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
311read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
312part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
313and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
314not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
0dbc1dd0
LT
315`kill-region' if read-only are involved: it copies the text to the
316kill-ring, but does not delete it.
21fb7588 317
d88beab5
KS
318** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
319the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
320
d1b2b8cc 321** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
879054ea 322
c78bf503 323+++
a27ddfaf
KS
324** New command line option -Q.
325
326This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
327the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, the blinking
328cursor, and the fancy startup screen.
329
70dce461
JL
330+++
331** New command line option -nbc or --no-blinking-cursor disables
332the blinking cursor on graphical terminals.
333
a775dff4 334+++
f8f853de
SM
335** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
336variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
337
a775dff4 338---
4ba2fd66
LT
339** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
340before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
341supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
342
a775dff4 343+++
4ba2fd66
LT
344** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
345If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
346mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
d1b2b8cc 347displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
4ba2fd66 348the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
d1b2b8cc 349just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
4ba2fd66
LT
350rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior may
351be mode dependent.
352
9f14953b
LT
353If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
354then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
355mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
356toggles this mode.
357
a775dff4 358+++
428b6b85
LT
359** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
360other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
361revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
362and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
d1b2b8cc 363mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
428b6b85
LT
364`revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
365decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
366that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
367work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
368
369** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
370Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
371control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
372which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
373only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
374
a775dff4 375+++
428b6b85
LT
376** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
377buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to `T' in Buffer Menu
378mode.
379
a775dff4 380---
d3a29dd8
DP
381** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
382
383Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
384recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
385red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
386(controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
387
e5c644da
DP
388Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
389This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
390This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
391
d3a29dd8
DP
392The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
393you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
394leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
395`compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
396that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
ecf4207f
SM
397
398The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
399
2a075e37
JL
400** Compilation mode enhancements:
401
4d894c98 402+++
2a075e37
JL
403*** New user option `compilation-environment'.
404This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
405compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
406subprocesses inherit.
407
408** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
409
a775dff4 410---
2a075e37
JL
411*** There's a new separate package grep.el.
412
a775dff4 413---
2a075e37 414*** M-x grep has been adapted to new compile
ecf4207f
SM
415
416Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
d1b2b8cc 417can be saved and automatically revisited with the new Grep mode.
ecf4207f 418
a775dff4 419---
2a075e37
JL
420*** Grep commands now have their own submenu and customization group.
421
3d4d788a
DK
422+++
423*** `grep-find' is now also available under the name `find-grep' where
424people knowing `find-grep-dired' would probably expect it.
425
a775dff4 426---
2a075e37
JL
427*** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
428`grep-scroll-output' can be used to override the corresponding
429compilation mode settings for grep commands.
430
a775dff4 431+++
2a075e37
JL
432*** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlightes matches in *grep*
433buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
434--color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
435match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
436buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
437source line is highlighted.
438
a775dff4 439+++
2a075e37
JL
440*** New key bindings in grep output window:
441SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
442previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
443the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
444other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
445previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
446file.
447
a775dff4 448+++
2a075e37
JL
449** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
450specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
451in new face `next-error'.
452
a775dff4 453+++
2a223f35
EZ
454** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
455compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
456modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
457buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
458matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
459C-c C-f.
f5e9cb97 460
a775dff4 461+++
ecf4207f
SM
462** M-x diff uses diff-mode instead of compilation-mode.
463
a775dff4 464+++
ee213e98
JL
465** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
466resync points in both windows.
467
2f9da07b
EZ
468** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
469This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
470the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
471using strokes as an input method.
472
23f87bed
MB
473** Gnus package
474
475*** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
476Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
477PGP/MIME.
478
479*** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
480See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
481
61d244ca
LH
482+++
483** Desktop package
484
a775dff4 485+++
61d244ca
LH
486*** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, desktop-save-mode. Variable
487desktop-enable is obsolete. Customize desktop-save-mode to enable desktop
488saving.
489
a775dff4 490---
61d244ca
LH
491*** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
492buffer list.
493
a775dff4 494+++
200d028b
LH
495*** The desktop package can be customized to restore only some buffers immediately,
496remaining buffers are restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
497
61d244ca
LH
498*** New commands:
499 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
500 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
501 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
502 it was loaded.
200d028b
LH
503 - desktop-lazy-complete runs the desktop load to completion.
504 - desktop-lazy-abort aborts lazy loading of the desktop.
61d244ca
LH
505
506*** New customizable variables:
507 - desktop-save. Determins whether the desktop should be saved when it is
508 killed.
200d028b 509 - desktop-file-name-format. Format in which desktop file names should be saved.
61d244ca 510 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
200d028b
LH
511 - desktop-locals-to-save. List of local variables to save.
512 - desktop-globals-to-clear. List of global variables that `desktop-clear' will clear.
513 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp. Regexp identifying buffers that `desktop-clear'
514 should not delete.
515 - desktop-restore-eager. Number of buffers to restore immediately. Remaining buffers are
516 restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
517 - desktop-lazy-verbose. Verbose reporting of lazily created buffers.
518 - desktop-lazy-idle-delay. Idle delay before starting to create buffers.
61d244ca 519
a775dff4 520+++
61d244ca
LH
521*** New command line option --no-desktop
522
523*** New hooks:
524 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
525 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
526
b1faee6e
EZ
527---
528** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
529When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
530include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
531Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
532to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
533and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
534feature.
535
61042632
SM
536** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
537
538 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
539 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
540 % emacsclient -s foo file1
541 % emacsclient -s bar file2
542
ed2846bd 543+++
dcf0c8e0
KS
544** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
545(not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
546two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
547Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
548cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
549
550The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' may be set to nil to
4e07258f 551revert to the old behavior of continuing such lines.
dcf0c8e0 552
ed2846bd 553+++
b2b681f1
KS
554** The buffer boundaries (i.e. first and last line in the buffer) may
555now be marked with angle bitmaps in the fringes. In addition, up and
556down arrow bitmaps may be shown at the top and bottom of the left or
557right fringe if the window can be scrolled in either direction.
dcf0c8e0
KS
558
559This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
b2b681f1
KS
560`indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
561this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
562
563If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
f2a54fbc 564displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
b2b681f1 565
f2a54fbc
KS
566Value may also be an alist which specifies the presense and position
567of each bitmap individually.
b2b681f1 568
f2a54fbc
KS
569For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
570in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
571arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
572left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
dcf0c8e0 573
d18473b9
LT
574** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
575in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
576same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
577`help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
578keyboard oriented alternative.
579
580** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
581automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
582point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
583determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
584to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
585
586** New commands `scan-buf-next-region' and `scan-buf-previous-region'
587move to the start of the next (previous, respectively) region with
588non-nil help-echo property and display any help found there in the
589echo area, using `display-local-help'.
590
e5dadca7
LT
591+++
592** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
593preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
594hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
3f70fe82
LT
595preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
596hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
597enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
598anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node').
e5dadca7 599
a775dff4 600+++
cff5e534
SM
601** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
602On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
603
8fe7d8c8
RS
604+++
605** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
f8977ff3 606now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
8fe7d8c8
RS
607an interactively callable function.
608
609
668c2ab0
JB
610** sql changes.
611
612*** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
613SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
614buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
615session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
616SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
617
618The following values are supported:
619
620 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
621 db2 DB2
622 informix Informix
623 ingres Ingres
624 interbase Interbase
625 linter Linter
626 ms Microsoft
627 mysql MySQL
628 oracle Oracle
629 postgres Postgres
630 solid Solid
631 sqlite SQLite
632 sybase Sybase
633
634The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
635SQL mode indicator.
636
637The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
638your .emacs will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
639`sql-product' to accomplish this.
640
2c2cd44f
SM
641ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
642
668c2ab0
JB
643*** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
644font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
645all identifiers ending in "_t" under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
646you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
647
648 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
2c2cd44f 649 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
668c2ab0
JB
650
651*** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i. Most
652SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
653highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
654
655*** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
656Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
657sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
e4aaf69c 658osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
668c2ab0
JB
659are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
660terminated.
661
662If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
663called with the -E command line argument to use the operating system
664credentials to authenticate the user.
665
2c2cd44f
SM
666*** Postgres support is enhanced.
667Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
668the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
669
670*** MySQL support is enhanced.
671Keyword higlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
672
668c2ab0
JB
673*** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
674packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
675defaults.
676
677*** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
678appropriate sql-interactive-mode wrapper for the current setting of
679`sql-product'.
680
80384936
RS
681** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
682with special modes such as Tar mode.
683
ee216b2c
KS
684** Enhancements to apropos commands:
685
a775dff4 686+++
d1b2b8cc 687*** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
ee216b2c
KS
688When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
689be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
690available.
691
692*** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
693to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
694number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
695regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
696match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
697matching item.
800bebe3 698
c6de56a0
RS
699+++
700** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
701since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
702the operating system or your X server.
703
704** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
d60f1316 705When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
668c2ab0 706restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
d60f1316 707
a775dff4 708---
d60f1316
LT
709** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
710By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
711
a1bcf785
JL
712** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
713`insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
714
a775dff4 715+++
a1bcf785
JL
716** A prefix argument of C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-printifies the
717list starting after point.
718
ee213e98
JL
719** Dired mode:
720
a775dff4 721---
ee213e98
JL
722*** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
723dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
724introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
725
a1bcf785
JL
726*** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
727with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
728
729+++
730*** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
731of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
ee213e98
JL
732
733+++
734*** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
735control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
736by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
737too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
738doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
739special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
740
a775dff4 741+++
ee213e98 742*** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
a1bcf785 743into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
ee213e98 744
61d244ca
LH
745+++
746** Dired-x:
747
748*** Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode. The mode toggling
749command is bound to M-o. A new command dired-mark-omitted, bound to M-O,
750marks omitted files. The variable dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the
751mode toggling function instead.
752
8ab314f9
JL
753+++
754** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
755when the file name contains wildcard characters.
756
757+++
758** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
759when the file name contains wildcard characters.
760
761** FFAP
762
763+++
764*** New ffap commands and keybindings: C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
765C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
766C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
767C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
768
769---
770*** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default. C-x C-f passes
771it to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS argument, which visits
772multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
773
43ea9947 774** Info mode:
a1bcf785 775
a775dff4 776+++
a1bcf785 777*** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
dc257129 778with the number appended to the *info* buffer name (e.g. "*info*<2>").
a1bcf785 779
a775dff4 780---
91c66262 781*** isearch in Info uses Info-search and searches through multiple nodes.
e12cd189
JL
782Before leaving the initial Info node isearch fails once with the error
783message [initial node], and with subsequent C-s/C-r continues through
784other nodes. When isearch fails for the rest of the manual, it wraps
785aroung the whole manual to the top/final node. The user option
786`Info-isearch-search' controls whether to use Info-search for isearch,
787or the default isearch search function that wraps around the current
788Info node.
0dfddff5
JL
789
790*** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
791`Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
792search without prompting for a new search string.
793
dc257129
JL
794*** New command `Info-history-forward' (bound to r and new toolbar icon)
795moves forward in history to the node you returned from after using
796`Info-history-back' (renamed from `Info-last').
797
a1bcf785
JL
798*** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
799
800*** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
801from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
802
803*** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
804Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
805possible matches.
806
807*** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
808the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
809arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
810
a1bcf785
JL
811*** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
812and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
813
814*** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
815references and following them calls `browse-url'.
816
d60f1316 817+++
43ea9947 818*** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
d60f1316
LT
819If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
820`Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
821
7dcac3a6
JL
822*** Images in Info pages are supported.
823Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
824Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
825version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
826
ee213e98
JL
827+++
828*** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
829
830---
831*** Info-index offers completion.
832
a775dff4 833---
5d0ab731
JB
834** Support for the SQLite interpreter has been added to sql.el by calling
835'sql-sqlite'.
836
bf078377 837** BibTeX mode:
d528bff7 838*** The new command bibtex-url browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
e0dc0c55
SM
839point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
840
c20052b2
SM
841*** The new command bibtex-entry-update (bound to C-c C-u) updates
842an existing BibTeX entry.
e0dc0c55 843
bf078377 844*** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
e0dc0c55 845
bf078377
SM
846*** bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries can take values `plain',
847`crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
e0dc0c55
SM
848for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
849scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
a6aa9850
KG
850automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
851bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries is non-nil.
852
853*** If the new variable bibtex-parse-keys-fast is non-nil,
854use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
855
856*** If the new variable bibtex-autoadd-commas is non-nil,
857automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
858
859*** The new variable bibtex-autofill-types contains a list of entry
860types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
861
862*** The new command bibtex-complete completes word fragment before
863point according to context (bound to M-tab).
864
865*** The new commands bibtex-find-entry and bibtex-find-crossref
02c8032e
SM
866locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
867Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
a6aa9850
KG
868
869*** In BibTeX mode the command fill-paragraph (bound to M-q) fills
870individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
bf078377 871
02c8032e
SM
872*** The new variables bibtex-files and bibtex-file-path define a set
873of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
e0dc0c55 874
02c8032e 875*** The new command bibtex-validate-globally checks for duplicate keys
e0dc0c55
SM
876in multiple BibTeX files.
877
878*** The new command bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill pushes summary
879of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
880
a775dff4 881+++
6f8968c8
KS
882** When display margins are present in a window, the fringes are now
883displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
884at the edges of the window.
885
a775dff4 886+++
bd9b2b20 887** A window may now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
6f8968c8
KS
888in addition to the individual display margin settings.
889
890Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
bd9b2b20 891horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
6f8968c8
KS
892or when the frame is resized.
893
fbe57420
KS
894** New functions frame-current-scroll-bars and window-current-scroll-bars.
895
896These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
fd940504 897horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
fbe57420 898
a775dff4 899+++
0074d3a0
JD
900** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
901 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
902 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
903
a775dff4 904+++
2a89019f
SM
905** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
906
c67de8ba
DL
907** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which may
908speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
909
42f81f64
KS
910If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
911XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
912
a775dff4 913+++
a95cefd7 914** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
c64a682c
SM
915
916** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
917`file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
918
a775dff4 919+++
c64a682c 920** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
d1b2b8cc 921Emacs prompts her for confirmation.
c64a682c 922
a775dff4 923---
347003be
DL
924** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
925
a775dff4 926---
556621f6
NR
927** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
928and other common debugger commands.
929
1d1d1b1f
JB
930** recentf changes.
931
932The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
933enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
934automatic cleanup.
935
936With the more advanced option: `recentf-filename-handler', you can
937specify a function that transforms filenames handled by recentf. For
938example, if set to `file-truename', the same file will not be in the
939recent list with different symbolic links.
940
941To follow naming convention, `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-flag'
942and `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag' respectively replace the
943misnamed options `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p' and
944`recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The old names remain available as
945aliases, but have been marked obsolete.
946
a775dff4 947+++
4cdf4bde
DL
948** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
949from the locale.
61cb0b53 950
a775dff4 951+++
5ab0ceed
RS
952** Init file changes
953
954You can now put the init files .emacs and .emacs_SHELL under
955~/.emacs.d or directly under ~. Emacs will find them in either place.
956
a775dff4 957---
0ec6b206
SM
958** partial-completion-mode now does partial completion on directory names.
959
ff6a3bfb
RS
960** skeleton.el now supports using - to mark the skeleton-point without
961 interregion interaction. @ has reverted to only setting
962 skeleton-positions and no longer sets skeleton-point. Skeletons
963 which used @ to mark skeleton-point independent of _ should now use -
964 instead. The updated skeleton-insert docstring explains these new
965 features along with other details of skeleton construction.
966
a1b4049d
BW
967** MH-E changes.
968
eccf9613 969Upgraded to MH-E version 7.82. There have been major changes since
a1b4049d
BW
970version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
971
5b8b9fa7 972+++
175573ac
DL
973** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
974`--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given elisp
975expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
976
a775dff4 977+++
175573ac 978** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
5b8b9fa7 979
f5d0cc77
RS
980+++
981** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
982When the file is maintained under version control, that information
983appears between the position information and the major mode.
2c37653c 984
a775dff4 985+++
957e7c38
RS
986** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
987against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
988
2e4e635a
RS
989+++
990** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
991for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
992top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
993control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
994set-fringe-style.
555c87d8 995
2e4e635a 996+++
d7b590b1
MR
997** There is a new user option `mail-default-directory' that allows you
998to specify the value of `default-directory' for mail buffers. This
999directory is used for auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to
1000"~/".
1001
2b6bb1f2 1002+++
af7272b1
RS
1003** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
1004read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
d1b2b8cc
RS
1005want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
1006file.)
af7272b1 1007
a775dff4 1008+++
cc305a60
RS
1009** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
1010revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
1011
8798ecdb
KH
1012** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
1013of a file.
1014
dacec596 1015---
4cdf4bde 1016** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
dacec596
EZ
1017
1018Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
1019ps-print, provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF fonts.
1020See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
1021
b03763f4
EZ
1022---
1023** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
1024`buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
1025in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
1026
1027`buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
1028leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
d1b2b8cc 1029If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
b03763f4
EZ
1030shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
1031and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
1032
1033`buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
1034the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
1035t, and the status is shown.
1036
1037Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
1038the Buffers menu is regenerated.
1039
2e4e635a 1040+++
4d3eda1c 1041** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
2e4e635a
RS
1042now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
1043specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
1044faces.
4d3eda1c 1045
a775dff4 1046---
b51dcd14 1047** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
175573ac 1048Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
4cdf4bde
DL
1049Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
1050Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
1051automatically according to the locale.)
175573ac 1052
a775dff4 1053---
175573ac
DL
1054** Indian support has been updated.
1055The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
1056assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
4cdf4bde
DL
1057Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
1058supported.
fc2938d1 1059
813f3d41 1060---
fc2938d1
DL
1061** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
1062ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
1063vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
1064latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
4cdf4bde
DL
1065bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
1066tamil-inscript.
fc2938d1 1067
813f3d41
RS
1068---
1069** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
1070in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
1071Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
1072
1073---
fc2938d1
DL
1074** Many new coding systems are available by loading the `code-pages'
1075library. These include complete versions of most of those in
30955b19
EZ
1076codepage.el, based on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now
1077obsolete and is used only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. windows-1252
1078and windows-1251 are preloaded since the former is so common and the
1079latter is used by GNU locales.
fc2938d1 1080
a775dff4 1081---
347003be 1082** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
66189a40
KH
1083By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
1084single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
1085turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
1086sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
1087system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
1088interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
347003be
DL
1089You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
1090`ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
1091coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
742f8710 1092one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
347003be 1093The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
a4ac5b17 1094
a775dff4 1095---
af3b9e47
KH
1096** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
1097Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
1098
a775dff4 1099---
a4ac5b17
DL
1100** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
1101characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
1102fontset appropriately.
fc2938d1 1103
a775dff4 1104---
fc2938d1 1105** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
a4ac5b17 1106unicode.
fc2938d1 1107
1c6576ab 1108+++
a4ac5b17
DL
1109** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
1110Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
1111the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
1112Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
1113sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
1114translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
1115mule-unicode-... ones.
1116
d1b2b8cc 1117By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
a4ac5b17
DL
1118Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
1119with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
1120possible.
fc2938d1
DL
1121
1122You can force a more complete unification with the user option
1123unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
1124into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
a4ac5b17
DL
1125mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
1126will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
fc2938d1 1127
a775dff4 1128---
fc2938d1
DL
1129** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
1130either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
1131when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
e9b9ec8b 1132controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
8f9891ab 1133
7443bd8e
KH
1134** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
1135coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
1136(Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
1137command.
1138
2a1e884e 1139---
2e4e635a 1140** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
5a597a71
SM
1141On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
1142amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
1143
ecb3b438
JD
1144---
1145** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
fb40303e 1146be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
ecb3b438
JD
1147
1148---
fb40303e
JD
1149** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
1150ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
1151
e2a57f28
JD
1152---
1153** Dialogs and menus pop down when pressing C-g.
1154
fb40303e
JD
1155---
1156** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
1157and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
1158to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
ecb3b438 1159
1394f7f5 1160+++
fb40303e 1161** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
1394f7f5
JD
1162disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
1163
cba71f24
JD
1164+++
1165** For Gtk+ version 2.4, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
3a0ab7ec 1166by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
cba71f24
JD
1167the new dialog.
1168
267bdad3
EZ
1169+++
1170** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
1171The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
1172default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
1173cursor does.
1174
23706d6c
KS
1175+++
1176** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
1177now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
1178
c0e48b0b
RS
1179** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
1180various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
1181program files that include other program files.
1182
1183Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
1184all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
1185in them.
1186
172f1af1
EZ
1187---
1188** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
1189when Emacs visits them.
1190
2a1e884e 1191---
ded0c207
EZ
1192** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
1193
1194`mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
1195default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
1196automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
1197
b5d2c621
KH
1198** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
1199requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
1200Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
1201and use the more appropriately result.
1202
63a4cd16
EZ
1203+++
1204** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
63a7fdcf
EZ
1205The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
1206the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
1207will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
1a667242 1208
63a7fdcf 1209The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
d1b2b8cc 1210hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
63a7fdcf
EZ
1211window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
1212window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
1213many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
1214gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
1215
813f3d41
RS
1216The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
1217`auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
1218
bf078377 1219** TeX modes:
a775dff4 1220
a95cefd7 1221*** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
a775dff4 1222
2a1e884e 1223+++
0ec6b206 1224*** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
63bfbe6f
RS
1225by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
1226command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
1227TeX commands to use at startup.
a775dff4 1228
0ec6b206
SM
1229*** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
1230and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
63bfbe6f 1231
c64a682c
SM
1232*** New major mode doctex-mode for *.dtx files.
1233
2a1e884e 1234+++
b0ada147
RS
1235** New display feature: focus follows the mouse from one Emacs window
1236to another, even within a frame. If you set the variable
1237mouse-autoselect-window to non-nil value, moving the mouse to a
1238different Emacs window will select that window (minibuffer window can
1239be selected only when it is active). The default is nil, so that this
1240feature is not enabled.
3996d07a 1241
62ce3608
KS
1242** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
1243select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
1244normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
1245the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
fa7f39ad 1246window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
62ce3608
KS
1247to give it focus.
1248
1c6576ab
RS
1249+++
1250** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
1251description various information about a character, including its
d6696bb6
KH
1252encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
1253widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
1254clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
c145bbb3 1255
81f755ae
CW
1256+++
1257** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1258search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1259`multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
1260buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
1261rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
1262
1791907b
DK
1263** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
1264been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
1265in Indented-Text mode.
1266
1267** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
1268`query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
1269a match if part of it has a read-only property.
1270
a775dff4 1271+++
1791907b
DK
1272** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
1273`replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
1274where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
1275time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
59035302
JL
1276`query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
1277to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
1278All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
1279replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
1280can be edited for each replacement.
1791907b 1281
a775dff4 1282+++
a31a30b5
JL
1283** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
1284`query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
1285
a775dff4 1286---
a31a30b5
JL
1287** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
1288`query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
836c086b 1289
255ec1b0 1290+++
b2bd7aff
RS
1291** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
1292is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
1293can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
1294mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
1295also disable mouse highlighting.
90e87070 1296
26fb226b
KS
1297** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
1298shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
1299variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
1300
2a1e884e 1301+++
fd42af9d
SM
1302** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
1303an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
1304font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
1305if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
1306trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
1307
236f1c76
EZ
1308+++
1309** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
1310Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
1311variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
1312prompt string.
1313
9a770d8d 1314+++
fd4f8b36
KS
1315** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
1316of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
1317the mode line of the currently selected window.
1318
89f8199f
KS
1319The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
1320the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
1321
2e4e635a 1322---
1f600b1b 1323** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
2e4e635a
RS
1324This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
1325as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
1326You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
1327it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
1328current date and time, current line and column number in the
1329mode-line.
1f600b1b 1330
2e4e635a 1331---
a9c6d330
PA
1332** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
1333
2a1e884e 1334+++
347003be 1335** Emacs can now indicate in the mode-line the presence of new e-mail
2a1e884e 1336in a directory or in a file. See the documentation of the user option
7c961dc2 1337`display-time-mail-directory'.
2d4ef682 1338
a4fc6fc9
PJ
1339---
1340** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
1341
e58d8457 1342+++
5e101746 1343** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
e58d8457 1344M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
5e101746
RS
1345argument it toggles the mode.
1346
1347Turning off PC-Selection mode restores the global key bindings
1348that were replaced by turning on the mode.
1349
2e4e635a 1350+++
b54cfb55
CW
1351** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
1352arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
1353disables the splash screen; see also the variable
1354`inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
1355`inhibit-splash-screen').
1356
7cc8f35a
EZ
1357** Changes in support of colors on character terminals
1358
e0c124ce 1359+++
7cc8f35a 1360*** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
e0c124ce
EZ
1361mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
1362terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
1363database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
1364set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
1365terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
1366when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
1367in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
1368user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
1369
7cc8f35a
EZ
1370---
1371*** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
1372than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
1373256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
1374the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
1375all of these colors.
1376
11a365f9
EZ
1377+++
1378*** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
1379faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
1380256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
138188-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
1382colors as on X.
1383
7cc8f35a
EZ
1384---
1385*** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
1386
6625fc7d
EZ
1387+++
1388** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
1389
1390When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
1391`--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
1392whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
616d7a51 1393screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
6625fc7d 1394
2b6bb1f2 1395---
a8f57660 1396** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
2b6bb1f2 1397automatically.
cb8d4d07 1398
2b6bb1f2 1399+++
eaffd16d 1400** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
4e3dd7cf
MB
1401modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1402like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1403otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1404
2b6bb1f2 1405+++
00b1ee61
RS
1406** Changes in C-h bindings:
1407
1408C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
1409
1410C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
1411 that do not change:
1412
1413C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
1414C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
1415
1416The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
1417have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
1418
93607efd
KS
1419C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
1420
1421- C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
1422 run by the key sequence.
1423
1424- C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
1425 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
1426 that command.
1427
1428For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
bf8dd4e3 1429to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
93607efd
KS
1430
1431- C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
1432 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
1433
1434- C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
1435 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
1436
1437- C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
1438 new-kill-line is on C-k
1439
e42d6474
EZ
1440+++
1441** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
1442To enable this feature, customize the new user option
1443`isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
1444constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
1445for details.
1446
2b6bb1f2 1447+++
a207b33c
RS
1448** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
1449making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
1450command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
1451bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
1452
e42d6474
EZ
1453+++
1454** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
1455at the end of a line.
1456
59035302
JL
1457+++
1458** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
1459Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
1460and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
1461
1462+++
dc29ba9b
JL
1463** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
1464`query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
1465search string used as the string to replace.
59035302 1466
2a075e37 1467+++
662b102f
KS
1468** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
1469history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
1470user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
2a075e37
JL
1471
1472+++
1473** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
1474If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
1475elements are deleted.
1476
2b6bb1f2 1477+++
d9f7eb77
RS
1478** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
1479be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
1480`yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
1481of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
1482
1c6576ab 1483+++
b54cfb55
CW
1484** Occur, Info, and comint-derived modes now support using
1485M-x font-lock-mode to toggle fontification. The variable
1486`Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable fontification,
1487remove `turn-on-font-lock' from `Info-mode-hook'.
1488
1c6576ab 1489+++
4e3dd7cf 1490** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
d1b2b8cc
RS
1491by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1492detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
4e3dd7cf
MB
1493When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1494unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1495command lines to be used than was possible before.
1496
1c6576ab 1497---
4e3dd7cf
MB
1498** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
1499In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
1500check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
1501for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
1502sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
1503its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
1504case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
1505
3116d142 1506+++
c721078e
RS
1507** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
1508the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
1509You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
1510under the "[State]" button.
1511
a775dff4 1512---
63db1bb3
MR
1513** The new customization type `float' specifies numbers with floating
1514point (no integers are allowed).
1515
2b6bb1f2
RS
1516+++
1517** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
4febb0e7
RS
1518counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
1519
2b6bb1f2 1520---
ca64d378 1521** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
a1e3dda0
RS
1522
1523*** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
1524 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
1525 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
1526 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
1527 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
1528
1529*** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
1530 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
1531 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
1532 (gud-finish).
1533
1534*** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
1535 (Java 1.1 jdb).
1536
1537*** The previous method of searching for source files has been
1538 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
1539 Set gud-jdb-use-classpath to nil.
1540
1541 Added Customization Variables
1542
1543*** gud-jdb-command-name. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
1544
1545*** gud-jdb-use-classpath. Allows selection of java source file searching
1546 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan gud-jdb-directories for
1547 java sources (previous method).
1548
1549*** gud-jdb-directories. List of directories to scan and search for java
1550 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if gud-jdb-use-classpath
1551 is nil).
1552
1553 Minor Improvements
1554
9e94e254
SJ
1555*** The STARTTLS elisp wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
1556instead of the OpenSSL based "starttls" tool. For backwards
d1b2b8cc 1557compatibility, it prefers "starttls", but you can toggle
9e94e254
SJ
1558`starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
1559"starttls" tool).
1560
a1e3dda0
RS
1561*** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
1562
1c6576ab 1563+++
43a88bc1
SM
1564** hide-ifdef-mode now uses overlays rather than selective-display
1565to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
d29bf2fa 1566changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
43a88bc1 1567
1c6576ab 1568+++
111ed14e
SM
1569** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
1570the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
1571Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
1572is only rarely needed.
1573
1c6576ab 1574---
cce5462e
SM
1575** JIT-lock changes
1576*** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
8ea55f33
EZ
1577
1578If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
fbe51115 1579idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
8ea55f33
EZ
1580example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
1581only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
f67cc62e 1582
cce5462e
SM
1583*** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
1584
1585jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
1586jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
1587refontification takes place.
1588
cad113ae
KG
1589+++
1590** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times. If
1591you hit M-C-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h (mark-paragraph), or
d1b2b8cc
RS
1592C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region extends each time, so
1593you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC M-C-SPC, for example.
1594This feature also works for mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to
6a2067b2
JL
1595a key. It also extends the region when the mark is active in Transient
1596Mark mode, regardless of the last command. To start a new region with
1597one of marking commands in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the
1598active region with C-g, or set the new mark with C-SPC.
6710ea06 1599
2b6bb1f2 1600+++
18f10eda
RS
1601** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
1602mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
1603region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
1604want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
2b6bb1f2
RS
1605ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
1606command only.
18f10eda 1607
2b6bb1f2
RS
1608One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
1609and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
1610This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
1611mark or the region.
32f665fa 1612
2b6bb1f2
RS
1613After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
1614deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
1615that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
1616C-g.
66aa61d8 1617
2b6bb1f2 1618+++
66aa61d8 1619** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
d1b2b8cc 1620previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
66aa61d8
KS
1621mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
1622
a775dff4 1623+++
6a2067b2 1624** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
a31a30b5
JL
1625`beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
1626is already active in Transient Mark mode.
6a2067b2 1627
1c6576ab 1628+++
a474d59c
RS
1629** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1630C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1631switching to it.
7c425d82 1632
1c6576ab 1633+++
7c425d82
RS
1634** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
1635all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
1636affects the initial frame.
1637
efe459e4 1638+++
fbe51115
PJ
1639** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
1640With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
564b1f76
EZ
1641if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
1642paragraphs.
efe459e4 1643
1c6576ab 1644+++
b04dcf45
RS
1645** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1646have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1647directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1648directory listing into a buffer.
1649
1c6576ab 1650---
6710ea06
SM
1651** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
1652(rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
1653
a775dff4 1654---
cc563ece
KS
1655** Unexpected yanking of text due to accidental clicking on the mouse
1656wheel button (typically mouse-2) during wheel scrolling is now avoided.
4e07258f 1657This behavior can be customized via the mouse-wheel-click-event and
cc563ece
KS
1658mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
1659
2b6bb1f2 1660+++
457c233a
DL
1661** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
1662current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
1663may mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
1664characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
1665emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
1666keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
1667or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
1668by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
16927a56 1669
3aa2f38a
RS
1670+++
1671** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
273a3930
EZ
1672automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
1673modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
1674can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
2bc8d7c8 1675according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
3aa2f38a 1676
1c6576ab 1677+++
830047fd
RS
1678** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
1679of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
1680appears in.
6c0b2643 1681
a775dff4 1682+++
d5ec54b6
KS
1683** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
1684of the recognized cursor types.
c60ee5e7 1685
1c6576ab 1686---
758bf24f
GM
1687** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
1688controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
1689attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
1690
1698fb36
GM
1691+++
1692** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
1693convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
1694
f5d0cc77
RS
1695+++
1696** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
1697Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
eca7b908 1698`diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
f5d0cc77
RS
1699which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
1700how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
1701single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
1702day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
1703face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
1704appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
1705
33d0b73f
GM
1706+++
1707** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
1708year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
1709count backward from the end of the year.
1710
554b59cd
GM
1711+++
1712** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
1713prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
1714day of that ISO week.
1715
f43ae016
GM
1716** The new variable `calendar-minimum-window-height' affects the
1717window generated by the function `generate-calendar-window'.
1718
988c3fe3 1719---
97f3be50 1720** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
94f1c41a
GM
1721optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
1722rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
1723`christian-holidays' simpler.
97f3be50 1724
b9e6b498
GM
1725** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
1726This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
1727and `diary-header-line-format'.
1728
0fbe422d
GM
1729+++
1730** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed: use
1731the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
1732`appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
1733appt-issue-message, appt-visible, and appt-msg-window.
1734
a775dff4 1735+++
d71d20ea
GM
1736** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
1737and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
1738from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
1739`diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
1740formats.
1741
1742
3f270c8a
AS
1743** VC Changes
1744
fc08c987
AS
1745*** The key C-x C-q no longer checks files in or out, it only changes
1746the read-only state of the buffer (toggle-read-only). We made this
1747change because we held a poll and found that many users were unhappy
1748with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this behavior, you
1749can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your .emacs:
1750
1751 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
1752
1753The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
1754
1c6576ab 1755+++
3f270c8a
AS
1756*** There is a new user option `vc-cvs-global-switches' that allows
1757you to specify switches that are passed to any CVS command invoked
1758by VC. These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which
1759means they are inserted before the command name. For example, this
1760allows you to specify a compression level using the "-z#" option for
1761CVS.
1762
a775dff4 1763+++
c64a682c
SM
1764*** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
1765
eb766f96
MK
1766** EDiff changes.
1767
16757dcf 1768+++
eb766f96
MK
1769*** When comparing directories.
1770Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
1771directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
1772from one directory to another.
1773
16757dcf 1774+++
eb766f96
MK
1775*** When comparing files or buffers.
1776Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
1777currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
1778then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
1779comparison.
1780
5d9c22fd 1781*** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
813f3d41
RS
1782backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
1783`ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
1784
ca8f3642 1785+++
e94a3679
FP
1786** Etags changes.
1787
73639417
FP
1788*** New regular expressions features
1789
1790**** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
df3eebcb
FP
1791The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
1792only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
1793--regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
1794where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
1795more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
6861f0e3
FP
1796(single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
1797expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
1798(which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
1799span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
1800and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
1801
2c37653c 1802**** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in Gcc.
6861f0e3
FP
1803The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
1804respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
1805CR, TAB, VT,
1806
2c37653c 1807**** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
df3eebcb
FP
1808The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
1809only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
1810particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
1811
2c37653c 1812**** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
df3eebcb
FP
1813The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
1814per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
1815
73639417
FP
1816*** New language parsing features
1817
d9256ccb
FP
1818**** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
1819Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
1820
5dc59f2e
FP
1821**** The gnucc __attribute__ keyword is now recognised and ignored.
1822
dfcb9727
FP
1823**** New language HTML.
1824Title and h1, h2, h3 are tagged. Also, tags are generated when name= is
1825used inside an anchor and whenever id= is used.
1826
1827**** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
1828If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
1829size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
1830
5dc59f2e
FP
1831**** New language Lua.
1832All functions are tagged.
dfcb9727 1833
73639417 1834**** In Perl, packages are tags.
81d66c62
FP
1835Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
1836as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
1837package::sub.
1838
dfcb9727
FP
1839**** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
1840
2c37653c
FP
1841**** New language PHP.
1842Tags are functions, classes and defines.
5dc59f2e 1843If the --members option is specified to etags, tags are variables also.
f175bfff 1844
73639417 1845**** New default keywords for TeX.
a0bbc0c5
FP
1846The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
1847renewenvironment.
1848
81d66c62
FP
1849*** Honour #line directives.
1850When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
1851directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
1852specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
1853created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
1854writes tags pointing to the source file.
bf8dd4e3 1855
2c37653c 1856*** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
a0bbc0c5 1857This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
5cc4f104 1858be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
dfcb9727 1859reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
a0bbc0c5 1860the file FILE.
06ee6fcd 1861
c30567b7 1862+++
b5a67081
MS
1863** CC Mode changes.
1864
1865*** Font lock support.
1866CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
1867supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
1868package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
1869locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
1870AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
1871different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
1872
1873The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
1874dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
1875strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
1876declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
1877lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
1878the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
1879demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
1880therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
1881variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
1882
1883Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
1884fontification in mind, i.e. there should be a support mode that waits
1885with the fontification until the text is actually shown
1886(e.g. Just-in-time Lock mode, which is the default, or Lazy Lock
1887mode). Fontifying a file with several thousand lines in one go can
1888take the better part of a minute.
1889
1890**** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
1891are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
1892be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
1893locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
1894properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
1895not contain patterns for uncertain types.
1896
1897**** Support for documentation comments.
1898There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
1899Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
1900language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
1901buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
1902
1903Currently two kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Suns Javadoc
1904and Autodoc which is used in Pike. This is by no means a complete
1905list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor of choice
1906is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
1907
1908**** Better handling of C++ templates.
1909As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
1910now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
1911given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
1912parens.
1913
1914This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
1915work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
1916template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
1917recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
1918not as configurable as it ought to be.
1919
1920**** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
1921Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
1922The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
1923All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
1924handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
1925
1926*** Support for the AWK language.
1927Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
1928based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
1929any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
1930Here is a summary:
1931
1932**** Indentation Engine
1933The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
1934
1935AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
1936which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
1937placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
1938are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
1939definition, or structured statement.
1940
1941The predefined indentation functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
1942mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't be
1943any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
1944
1945The command C-c C-q (c-indent-defun) hasn't yet been adapted for AWK,
1946though in practice it works properly nearly all the time. Should it
1947fail, explicitly set the region around the function (using C-u C-SPC:
1948C-M-h probably won't work either) then do C-M-\ (indent-region).
1949
1950**** Font Locking
1951There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
1952three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
1953idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
1954the AWK language itself.
1955
1956**** Comment Commands
1957M-; (indent-for-comment) works fine. None of the other CC Mode
1958comment formatting commands have yet been adapted for AWK mode.
1959
1960**** Movement Commands
1961Most of the movement commands work in AWK mode. The most important
1962exceptions are M-a (c-beginning-of-statement) and M-e
1963(c-end-of-statement) which haven't yet been adapted.
1964
1965The notion of "defun" has been augmented to include AWK pattern-action
1966pairs. C-M-a (c-awk-beginning-of-defun) and C-M-e (c-awk-end-of-defun)
1967recognise these pattern-action pairs, as well as user defined
1968functions.
1969
1970**** Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
1971Auto-newline insertion hasn't yet been adapted for AWK. Some of
1972the clean-ups can actually convert good AWK code into syntactically
1973invalid code. These features are best disabled in AWK buffers.
1974
1975*** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
1976The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
1977now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
1978module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
1979composition-close, and incomposition.
1980
1981*** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
1982The functions c-hungry-backspace and c-hungry-delete-forward can be
1983bound to keys to get this feature without toggling a mode.
1984Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
1985
1db7dd46
RS
1986*** Better control over require-final-newline. The variable that
1987controls how to handle a final newline when the buffer is saved,
1988require-final-newline, is now customizable on a per-mode basis through
1989c-require-final-newline. That is a list of modes, and only those
1990modes set require-final-newline. By default that's C, C++ and
1991Objective-C.
1992
678d2655 1993The specified modes set require-final-newline based on
1db7dd46 1994mode-require-final-newline, as usual.
b5a67081 1995
94b562dc
MS
1996*** Format change for syntactic context elements.
1997The elements in the syntactic context returned by c-guess-basic-syntax
1998and stored in c-syntactic-context has been changed somewhat to allow
1999attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
2000cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
2001
2002((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
2003
2004is now analysed as
2005
2006((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
2007
2008In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
2009symbol.
2010
2011This change might affect code that call c-guess-basic-syntax directly,
2012and custom lineup functions if they use c-syntactic-context. However,
2013the argument given to lineup functions is still a single cons cell
2014with nil or an integer in the cdr.
b5a67081
MS
2015
2016*** API changes for derived modes.
2017There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
2018derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
2019incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
2020care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
2021Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
2022
2023**** New language variable system.
2024See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
2025
2026**** New initialization functions.
2027The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
2028give better control: c-basic-common-init, c-font-lock-init, and
2029c-init-language-vars.
2030
2031*** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
2032The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
2033several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
2034now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
2035
2036This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
2037although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
2038gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
2039where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
2040it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
2041
2042**** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
2043This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
2044its substatement. E.g:
2045
2046 if (x)
2047 x_is_true:
2048 do_stuff();
2049
2050*** Better handling of multiline macros.
2051
2052**** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
2053The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
2054syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
2055variable c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros. A new syntactic symbol
2056cpp-define-intro has been added to control the initial indentation
2057inside #define's.
2058
2059**** New lineup function c-lineup-cpp-define.
2060Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
2061of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
2062is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
2063removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
2064much line c-lineup-dont-change, which was used earlier, but handles
2065empty lines within the macro better.
2066
2067**** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
2068This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
2069c-context-line-break and c-context-open-line.
2070
2071**** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2072c-backslash-region tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
2073variable c-backslash-max-column which put a limit on how far out
2074backslashes can be moved.
2075
2076**** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
2077This is controlled by the new variable c-auto-align-backslashes. It
2078affects c-context-line-break, c-context-open-line and newlines
2079inserted in auto-newline mode.
2080
2081**** Line indentation works better inside macros.
2082Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
2083inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
2084line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
2085indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
2086backslash) in the macro.
2087
2088*** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
2089The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
2090the variable c-indent-comment-alist. The indentation behavior based
2091on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after #else
2092and #endif but indentation to comment-column in most other cases
2093(something which was hardcoded earlier).
2094
2095*** New function c-context-open-line.
2096It's the open-line equivalent of c-context-line-break.
2097
2098*** New lineup functions
2099
2100**** c-lineup-string-cont
2101This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
2102continues. E.g:
2103
2104result = prefix + "A message "
2105 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
2106
2107**** c-lineup-cascaded-calls
2108Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
2109
2110**** c-lineup-knr-region-comment
2111Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
2112the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
2113
2114**** c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg
2115Provides better indentation inside asm blocks. Contributed by Kevin
2116Ryde.
2117
2118**** c-lineup-argcont
2119Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
2120Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
2121
2122*** Better caching of the syntactic context.
2123CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
2124of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
2125places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
2126improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
2127moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
2128
2129The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
2130opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
2131only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
2132file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
2133context.
2134
2135*** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
2136Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
2137"invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
2138happen when macros are involved.
2139
2140*** Improved the way c-indent-exp chooses the block to indent.
2141It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
2142whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
2143point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
2144Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
2145line is left untouched.
2146
2147*** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
2148The function c-toggle-syntactic-indentation can be used to toggle
2149syntactic indentation.
2150
a775dff4 2151+++
406f228c
PJ
2152** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
2153--no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
2154
1c6576ab 2155+++
7ea42709
RS
2156** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
2157C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
2158
1c6576ab 2159+++
3a426197 2160** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
1c6576ab
RS
2161with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
2162whose names begin with space are omitted.
c30567b7 2163
2b6bb1f2 2164+++
3a426197 2165** You can now customize fill-nobreak-predicate to control where
ba2c991c
RS
2166filling can break lines. The value is now normally a list of
2167functions, but it can also be a single function, for compatibility.
2168
2169We provide two sample predicates, fill-single-word-nobreak-p and
2170fill-french-nobreak-p, for use in the value of fill-nobreak-predicate.
8e8223e2 2171
1c6576ab 2172+++
1d57ac82 2173** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
d1b2b8cc
RS
2174When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
2175starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1d57ac82 2176
2b6bb1f2 2177+++
2881ae98
SM
2178** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
2179The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
54c0e682 2180When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
79014980 2181i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2881ae98 2182By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
54c0e682 2183from the file name or buffer contents.
79014980 2184
2b6bb1f2 2185+++
9252f7bc 2186** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
cb8d4d07 2187
2a1e884e 2188---
1c6576ab 2189** Lisp mode now uses font-lock-doc-face for the docstrings.
30de4b24 2190
1c6576ab
RS
2191---
2192** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
30de4b24 2193
2d588beb 2194+++
1c6576ab 2195** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
2d588beb
GM
2196Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
2197Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
a68c5400 2198
a775dff4 2199+++
1c6576ab 2200** F90 mode has new navigation commands `f90-end-of-block',
0d9e03be 2201`f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block', `f90-previous-block'.
e47b1d49 2202
a775dff4 2203---
2c375837
GM
2204** F90 mode now has support for hs-minor-mode (hideshow).
2205It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
2206majority.
2207
f607ff4b
GM
2208---
2209** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
2210the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
2211
1c6576ab
RS
2212---
2213** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
2629d743
TTN
2214to support use of font-lock.
2215
1c6576ab 2216+++
026f408d
SM
2217** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
2218understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
2219`same-window'.
2220
1c6576ab 2221+++
6c0b2643
GM
2222** M-x setenv now expands environment variables of the form `$foo' and
2223`${foo}' in the specified new value of the environment variable. To
2224include a `$' in the value, use `$$'.
2225
30743573 2226+++
58a11372
EZ
2227** File-name completion can now ignore directories.
2228If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
2229slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
2230completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
2231which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
2232candidate is a directory.
2233
1c6576ab 2234+++
af7272b1
RS
2235** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
2236to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
1c6576ab
RS
2237it remains unchanged.
2238
a775dff4 2239---
6a4940b2
MY
2240** Enhanced visual feedback in *Completions* buffer.
2241
2242Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
2243have in common and where they begin to differ.
2244
2245The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
2246`completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
2247same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
2248`completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
2249`completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
2250`completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
2251parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
2252parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
8bdbf30d 2253
2a1e884e 2254+++
6c0b2643
GM
2255** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
2256When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
2257displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
2258
2a1e884e 2259---
6c0b2643
GM
2260** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
2261
ad8f7f49
EZ
2262+++
2263** Support for `movemail' from GNU mailutils was added to Rmail.
2264This version of `movemail' allows to read mail from a wide range of
2265mailbox formats, including remote POP3 and IMAP4 mailboxes with or
2266without TLS encryption. If GNU mailutils is installed on the system
2267and its version of `movemail' can be found in exec-path, it will be
2268used instead of the native one.
2269
2a1e884e 2270---
d3d268d5
JR
2271** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
2272This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
2273the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
2274
2a1e884e 2275---
f58b2333
JR
2276** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
2277See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
2278
2a1e884e 2279---
3b7db268
JR
2280** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
2281PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
2282depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
2283to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
2284http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
2285zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
9fc2be4c 2286against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
a3dde781 2287
f85bf1bf
JR
2288---
2289** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
2290WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
6c098dbe 2291as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
f85bf1bf
JR
2292Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
2293sound support for those formats.
2294
6c098dbe
JR
2295---
2296** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
2297The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
2298
1c6576ab 2299---
01a7f683
JR
2300** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
2301The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
2302whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
2303pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
2304
d18c4f98
JR
2305---
2306** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
d1b2b8cc
RS
2307The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
2308the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
2309colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
2310default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
2311some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
2312`list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
2313you wish to use them in other faces.
d18c4f98 2314
71e6cb01
JR
2315---
2316** On MS Windows NT/W2K/XP, Emacs uses Unicode for clipboard operations.
2317Those systems use Unicode internally, so this allows Emacs to share
2318multilingual text with other applications. On other versions of
2319MS Windows, Emacs now uses the appropriate locale coding-system, so
2320the clipboard should work correctly for your local language without
2321any customizations.
2322
2b6bb1f2 2323+++
98659da6
KG
2324** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
2325The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
2326and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
2327use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
2328Meta and Alt:
2329 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
2330 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
7aa518f3 2331
1ce8d8b1 2332+++
7aa518f3
AS
2333** vc-annotate-mode enhancements
2334
2335In vc-annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2336enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2337to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2338
2339 P: annotates the previous revision
2340 N: annotates the next revision
2341 J: annotates the revision at line
2342 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2343 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2344 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2345 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
d82baff9
KS
2346
2347+++
2348** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2349between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2350in the repository.
2351
5dc0a68b
JL
2352+++
2353** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2354anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2355"checkout", "update" or "commit". That means using cvs diff options
2356-rBASE -rHEAD.
2357
f3e4c362
TTN
2358** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
2359used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
2360handles the overlay property `display' specially, preserving it during
2361temporary overlay showing in the course of an isearch operation.
2362
a28e0218
KH
2363** New command `recode-region' decodes the region again by a specified
2364coding system.
2365
46937ad8 2366\f
bf247b6e 2367* New modes and packages in Emacs 22.1
8f8da2d0 2368
c7eb99ce
DP
2369** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
2370varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
2371var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
2372section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
2373.config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
2374recognized.
2375
3d3b45dc
SJ
2376** The new package password.el provide a password cache and expiring mechanism.
2377
a3ba1a6a
SJ
2378** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
2379The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
2380to increment the SOA serial.
2381
3fc3e0a6
JL
2382** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
2383source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
2384
a422e170
DP
2385** The library tree-widget.el provides a new widget to display a set
2386of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
2387well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
2388
723addae 2389** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
033ad8c6
SM
2390buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
2391
723addae
EZ
2392** The thumbs.el package allows you to preview image files as thumbnails
2393and can be invoked from a Dired buffer.
2394
1e88a355
SM
2395** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
2396
f8f853de
SM
2397** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
2398
5df034de
LK
2399+++
2400** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
2401shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
2402
a95cefd7 2403** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
556621f6 2404
8f8da2d0 2405---
cd3782b4
KS
2406** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2407
2408The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
2409package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
2410to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
2411a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
ffe5000a 2412
2b6bb1f2 2413---
cd3782b4
KS
2414** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2415
2416The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
2461722b
KS
2417cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
2418With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
2419keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
2420region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
2421cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
2422
2423In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
2424rectangle highlighting: Use S-return to start a rectangle, extend it
2425using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
2426or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
2427
2428Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
2429fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
2430downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
2431rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
2432as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
2433M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
2434rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
2435
2436Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
2437prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
2438C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
2439
2440The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
2441register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
2442
2443Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
2444When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
2445automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
2446commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
2447
2448The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
2449kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
2450want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you may customize the
2451`cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
2452
cd3782b4
KS
2453Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
2454versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
2455must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
2456loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
2457
4e5cdb4f 2458** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
7920598e
KS
2459the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
2460keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
2461+, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
2462package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
2463
2464By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
2465`keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
2466using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
2467the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
2468possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
2469the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
2470
2471The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
2472`Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
2473`Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
2474decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
2475`Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
2476for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
2477where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
63e489f5
KS
2478`Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
2479are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
2480or local keymaps.
2461722b 2481
d82baff9 2482+++
4e5cdb4f 2483** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
ffe5000a
KS
2484emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
2485
e1fa392b
KS
2486Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
2487F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
2488the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
ffe5000a
KS
2489which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
2490
cc801373
KS
2491There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
2492defined macros.
2493
2494The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
2495defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
2496C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
2497manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
2498C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
2499for more commands.
2500
2c37653c 2501The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
cc801373 2502the keyboard macro ring.
ffe5000a 2503
f1f83e21
KS
2504The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
2505before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
e1fa392b
KS
2506
2507In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
2508be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
4e07258f 2509this behavior via the variable kmacro-call-repeat-key and
e1fa392b
KS
2510kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
2511
f1f83e21 2512Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
d1b2b8cc 2513C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
f1f83e21
KS
2514at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
2515
675d000f
RS
2516---
2517** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2518to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2519bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2520C-c C-i b, and so on.
2521
cd3782b4
KS
2522** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2523
2524If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
2525the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
2526with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
2527ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
2528printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
2529`ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
2530
66f520db 2531+++
4e5cdb4f 2532** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
66f520db
EZ
2533
2534Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
2535Emacs Lisp. Its documentation is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
52901be1
EZ
2536type "C-h i m calc RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
2537available in `etc/calccard.tex' and `etc/calccard.ps'.
66f520db 2538
10088409 2539+++
4e5cdb4f 2540** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
c3d82b69
KG
2541
2542This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
2543files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
2544Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
2545for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
2546the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
2547`inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
2548connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
2549(which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
2550`rsync' to do the copying).
2551
2552Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
3235a9ea
MA
2553`su' and `sudo'. Ange-FTP is still supported via the `ftp' method.
2554
2555If you want to disable Tramp you should set
2556
2557 (setq tramp-default-method "ftp")
c3d82b69 2558
2a1e884e 2559---
4e5cdb4f 2560** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
49a42d13
MB
2561filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
2562that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
2563emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
2564invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method may
2565be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
4e3dd7cf 2566
2b6bb1f2 2567---
4e5cdb4f 2568** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
3c0fd84c
GM
2569"active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
2570change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
2571settings.
2572
2b6bb1f2 2573---
4e5cdb4f 2574** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
a95cefd7 2575move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
8a1f8073
SM
2576It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
2577of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
2578
2a1e884e 2579There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
adb6f9dc 2580
2a1e884e 2581---
4e5cdb4f 2582** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
81f755ae
CW
2583customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
2584
4e5cdb4f 2585** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
813f3d41
RS
2586`text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
2587these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
2588table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
2589can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
2590as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
2591
9cc1eb89 2592+++
4e5cdb4f
KS
2593** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
2594spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
2595letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
2596viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
2597
2a1e884e
RS
2598---
2599** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
4e3dd7cf
MB
2600Emacs will still work on terminals that require magic cookies in order
2601to use standout mode, however they will not be able to display
2602mode-lines in inverse-video.
2603
9252f7bc 2604---
eb6055fa 2605** cplus-md.el has been removed to avoid problems with Custom.
a8adf791 2606
500ae430
DL
2607** New package benchmark.el contains simple support for convenient
2608timing measurements of code (including the garbage collection component).
2609
bcdf2143 2610** The new Lisp library fringe.el controls the appearance of fringes.
46937ad8
DL
2611
2612** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
2613configuration files.
6c0b2643 2614\f
bf247b6e 2615* Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
60d1a807 2616
a775dff4
RS
2617** The new interactive-specification `G' reads a file name
2618much like `F', but if the input is a directory name (even defaulted),
2619it returns just the directory name.
2620
0a926c02
LT
2621+++
2622** `suppress-keymap' now works by remapping `self-insert-command' to
2623the command `undefined'. (In earlier Emacs versions, it used
2624`substitute-key-definition' to rebind self inserting characters to
2625`undefined'.)
2626
60d1a807
RS
2627+++
2628** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
2629:propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
2630`risky-local-variable' property is nil.
2631\f
bf247b6e 2632* Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
851e5562 2633
c7bd5d57
RS
2634+++
2635** An element of buffer-undo-list can now have the form (apply FUNNAME
2636. ARGS), where FUNNAME is a symbol other than t or nil. That stands
2637for a high-level change that should be undone by evaluating (apply
2638FUNNAME ARGS).
2639
2640These entries can also have the form (apply DELTA BEG END FUNNAME . ARGS)
2641which indicates that the change which took place was limited to the
2642range BEG...END and increased the buffer size by DELTA.
5a92a9eb 2643
8f958b40
KS
2644+++
2645** The line-move, scroll-up, and scroll-down functions will now
2646modify the window vscroll to scroll through display rows that are
2647taller that the height of the window, for example in the presense of
2648large images. To disable this feature, Lisp code may bind the new
2649variable `auto-window-vscroll' to nil.
2650
4ae98fc5
RS
2651+++
2652** If a buffer sets buffer-save-without-query to non-nil,
2653save-some-buffers will always save that buffer without asking
2654(if it's modified).
2655
56011a8c
RS
2656+++
2657** The function symbol-file tells you which file defined
2658a certain function or variable.
2659
c44edf72
KS
2660** Lisp code can now test if a given buffer position is inside a
2661clickable link with the new function `mouse-on-link-p'. This is the
2662function used by the new `mouse-1-click-follows-link' functionality.
2663
414ac1a3 2664+++
1113094c 2665** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
d9c1ce9d
RS
2666arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
2667quit had occurred. while-no-input returns the value of BODY, if BODY
2668finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted.
2669
414ac1a3
RS
2670+++
2671** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
2672precedence over the file name. Likewise an <?xml or <!DOCTYPE declaration
2673will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new var
2674`magic-mode-alist'.
2675
2676+++
2677** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
2678the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
2679back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
2680
2681+++
2682** New functions `make-progress-reporter', `progress-reporter-update',
f0d3d9fe
SM
2683`progress-reporter-force-update', `progress-reporter-done', and
2684`dotimes-with-progress-reporter' provide a simple and efficient way for
2685a command to present progress messages for the user.
414ac1a3 2686
593b3517
RS
2687---
2688** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
2689proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
2690"files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
2691several versions ago.
2692
9d00469f
RS
2693+++
2694** read-from-minibuffer now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
2695saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
2696
dedbac89
RS
2697+++
2698** The new variable search-spaces-regexp controls how to search
2699for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
2700regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
2701expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
2702
2703Spaces inside of constructs such as [..] and *, +, ? are never
2704replaced with search-spaces-regexp.
2705
ee31cd78
RS
2706---
2707** list-buffers-noselect now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
2708If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
2709
2710---
2711** set-buffer-file-coding-system now takes an additional argument,
2712NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
2713
ae8bbb42 2714+++
18819b0f
RS
2715** The new function syntax-after returns the syntax code
2716of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
2717of text properties as well as the character code.
18819b0f 2718
66fcf39c
EZ
2719+++
2720** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
2721run time used by Emacs since start-up.
2722
2d1ef312
RS
2723+++
2724** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
6dd06769
LT
2725have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' did: it returns t if the
2726calling function was called through `call-interactively'. This should
2727only be used when you cannot add a new "interactive" argument to the
2728command.
2729
2730+++
2731** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
2732`assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
2733been declared obsolete.
2d1ef312 2734
c8636435
KS
2735+++
2736** An interactive specification may now use the code letter 'U' to get
2737the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
2738previous 'k' or 'K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
2739
d0ee2ed3
KH
2740** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
2741argument.
2742
143e9e6a 2743+++
7320911b 2744** Major mode functions now run the new normal hook
6622d928 2745`after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode hooks.
7320911b 2746
a020987f
LT
2747+++
2748** `auto-save-file-format' has been renamed to
2749`buffer-auto-save-file-format' and made into a permanent local.
2750
c90e7e43
LT
2751+++
2752** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
8392e138 2753been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
c90e7e43
LT
2754`disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
2755
0f7a93c1
KS
2756** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
2757width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
2758the usable window height and width is used.
2759
cbbfedb2
LT
2760+++
2761** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
2762a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
2763
2764** If a command sets transient-mark-mode to `only', that
02c04e6f
RS
2765enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
2766During that following command, the value of transient-mark-mode
2767is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
2768it changes to nil.
376de739 2769
092de21d
RS
2770+++
2771** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
2772
2773You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
2774same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
2775example,
2776
2777(kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
2778
a775dff4 2779+++
0b0dea7b 2780** The sentinel is now called when a network process is deleted with
2e2d7ee6
KS
2781delete-process. The status message passed to the sentinel for a
2782deleted network process is "deleted". The message passed to the
2783sentinel when the connection is closed by the remote peer has been
2784changed to "connection broken by remote peer".
2785
a775dff4 2786+++
08fd1251
RS
2787** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
2788undo-outer-limit, garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
2789it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
2790
092de21d 2791---
d6696bb6
KH
2792** New function quail-find-key returns a list of keys to type in the
2793current input method to input a character.
2794
092de21d
RS
2795+++
2796** New functions posn-at-point and posn-at-x-y return
b144fc11
RS
2797click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
2798position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
09fe18d3 2799
a775dff4 2800+++
5b3dedcc
RS
2801** skip-chars-forward and skip-chars-backward now handle
2802character classes such as [:alpha:], along with individual characters
2803and ranges.
2804
a775dff4 2805+++
b144fc11
RS
2806** Function pos-visible-in-window-p now returns the pixel coordinates
2807and partial visiblity state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
2808arg is non-nil.
09fe18d3 2809
a775dff4 2810+++
98a51048
JPW
2811** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
2812
08818866
EZ
2813+++
2814** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
2815modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
2816operation.
2817
ed2846bd 2818+++
c1cbc25a
KS
2819** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
2820supported on text terminals.
2821
ed2846bd 2822+++
09fe18d3
KS
2823** Support for displaying image slices
2824
2825*** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) may be used with
2826an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
2827
2828*** Function insert-image has new optional fourth arg to
2829specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
2830
2831*** New function insert-sliced-image inserts a given image as a
2832specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
2833
ed2846bd 2834+++
06859ebd 2835** New line-height and line-spacing properties for newline characters
e5847e56 2836
26fb226b
KS
2837A newline may now have line-height and line-spacing text or overlay
2838properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
e5847e56 2839
678d2655 2840If the line-height property value is t, the newline does not
06859ebd 2841contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
6ab66799
KS
2842newline glyph is reduced. Also, a line-spacing property on this
2843newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
2844slices without adding blank areas between the images.
e5847e56 2845
06859ebd
KS
2846If the line-height property value is a positive integer, the value
2847specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
2848height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
e5847e56 2849
06859ebd 2850If the line-height property value is a float, the minimum line height
e71caa4e
KS
2851is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by the
2852given value.
06859ebd 2853
678d2655 2854If the line-height property value is a cons (FACE . RATIO), the
e71caa4e
KS
2855minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
2856RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
06859ebd 2857
678d2655
KS
2858If the line-height property value is a cons (nil . RATIO), the line
2859height is calculated as RATIO * actual height of the line's contents.
2860
2861If the line-height value is a cons (HEIGHT . TOTAL), HEIGHT specifies
2862the line height as described above, while TOTAL is any of the forms
2863described above and specifies the total height of the line, causing a
2864varying number of pixels to be inserted after the line to make it line
2865exactly that many pixels high.
2866
e71caa4e
KS
2867If the line-spacing property value is an positive integer, the value
2868is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
2869overrides the default frame line-spacing and any buffer local value of
2870the line-spacing variable.
06859ebd 2871
e71caa4e
KS
2872If the line-spacing property may be a float or cons, the line spacing
2873is calculated as specified above for the line-height property.
2874
a775dff4 2875+++
e71caa4e
KS
2876** The buffer local line-spacing variable may now have a float value,
2877which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
09fe18d3 2878
ed2846bd 2879+++
c1cbc25a
KS
2880** Enhancements to stretch display properties
2881
2882The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
2883PROPS is a property list now allows pixel based width and height
e4aaf69c 2884specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
c1cbc25a
KS
2885
2886The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
2887which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
2888are supported:
2889
2890EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
2891NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
2892UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
2893ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
2894 | scroll-bar | text
2895POS ::= left | center | right
2896FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
2897OP ::= + | -
2898
2899The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
2900frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
2901pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
2902is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
2903pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
2904`height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
2905font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
2906the image.
2907
2908The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
2909`scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
e4aaf69c 2910corresponding area of the window.
c1cbc25a
KS
2911
2912The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
2913to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
2914of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
2915can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
2916relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
2917a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
2918these symbols), further occurences of these symbols are interpreted as
2919the width of the area.
2920
2921For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
2922 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
2923
2924If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
2925to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
2926header-line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
2927
2928The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
2929the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
2930width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
2931height) of the specified image.
2932
2933The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
2934The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
2935
ed2846bd 2936+++
4e14f66c
KS
2937** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
2938text property string that may be present at the current window
2939position. The cursor may now be placed on any character of such
2940strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
2941
a775dff4 2942+++
982c8d45
SM
2943** New macro with-local-quit temporarily sets inhibit-quit to nil for use
2944around potentially blocking or long-running code in timers
2945and post-command-hooks.
2946
d9c1ce9d
RS
2947** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
2948`default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
2949defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and may be overridden
2950by them).
d3a403e5 2951
11a365f9
EZ
2952+++
2953** New face attribute `min-colors' can be used to tailor the face color
2954to the number of colors supported by a display, and define the
2955foreground and background colors accordingly so that they look best on
2956a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This is now the
2957preferred method for defining default faces in a way that makes a good
2958use of the capabilities of the display.
b19ac475 2959
ed2846bd
KS
2960+++
2961** Customizable fringe bitmaps
2962
f2a54fbc
KS
2963*** New function 'define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
2964fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
b2b681f1 2965
f2a54fbc
KS
2966To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
2967identifing the bitmap such as `left-truncation or `continued-line'.
b2b681f1 2968
ed2846bd 2969*** New function 'destroy-fringe-bitmap' may be used to destroy a
b2b681f1
KS
2970previously created bitmap, or restore a built-in bitmap.
2971
ed2846bd 2972*** New function 'set-fringe-bitmap-face' can now be used to set a
b2b681f1
KS
2973specific face to be used for a specific fringe bitmap. Normally,
2974this should be a face derived from the `fringe' face, specifying
2975the foreground color as the desired color of the bitmap.
2976
ed2846bd 2977*** There are new display properties, left-fringe and right-fringe,
b2b681f1
KS
2978that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
2979bitmap of the display line.
2980
2981Format is 'display '(left-fringe BITMAP [FACE]), where BITMAP is a
f2a54fbc 2982symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
b2b681f1
KS
2983`define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
2984for displaying the bitmap.
2985
35ab4857
KS
2986*** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
2987bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
b2b681f1 2988
a775dff4 2989+++
851e5562
KS
2990** Multiple overlay arrows can now be defined and managed via the new
2991variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'. It contains a list of
2992varibles which contain overlay arrow position markers, including
2993the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
2994
2995Each variable on this list may have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
2996and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
2997string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
2998systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
2999If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
3000'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
3001
4372d886
KS
3002+++
3003** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns line number of current
3004line in current buffer, or if optional buffer position is given, line
3005number of corresponding line in current buffer.
3006
9f4b6e73 3007+++
e91408d7
KH
3008** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
3009variable `sentence-end-without-space' which contains such characters
ac459e8a 3010that end a sentence without following spaces.
e91408d7 3011
9f4b6e73 3012+++
8bc51bd1
JL
3013** The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of
3014the variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil,
3015then this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
3016`sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
3017`sentence-end-without-space'.
3018
b19ac475
JY
3019+++
3020** The flags, width, and precision options for %-specifications in function
3021`format' are now documented. Some flags that were accepted but not
3022implemented (such as "*") are no longer accepted.
830047fd 3023
0610f22f
MB
3024** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
3025It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
3026One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
3027if no expansion is done, which may be tested using `eq'.
3028
9adcb5f2 3029+++
d0cd7210
LT
3030** New function `delete-dups' destructively removes `equal' duplicates
3031from a list. Of several `equal' occurrences of an element in the list,
43e48bda 3032the first one is kept.
d0cd7210 3033
3e7274ae
LT
3034+++
3035** `declare' is now a macro. This change was made mostly for
3036documentation purposes and should have no real effect on Lisp code.
3037
a775dff4 3038+++
652dd271
SJ
3039** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
3040before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
3041tasks, for example; it can be used by the copyright package to make
3042sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
3043
e2b9b51f 3044+++
53092de4
EZ
3045** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
3046`yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
3047string. The old behavior is available if you call
3048`insert-for-yank-1' instead.
3049
d18473b9
LT
3050** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
3051arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
3052return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
3053whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
3054it was found as a text property or not found at all.
3055
ed2846bd
KS
3056+++ (lispref)
3057??? (man)
69348b2a
KS
3058** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
3059line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
3060controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
3061is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
3062(or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
3063
ed2846bd 3064+++
69348b2a
KS
3065** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
3066:pointer image property.
3067
ed2846bd 3068+++
69348b2a
KS
3069** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images may now be
3070controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
3071
ed2846bd 3072+++
69348b2a
KS
3073** Images may now have an associated image map via the :map property.
3074
3075An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
3076An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
3077A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1))) specifying the
3078pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
3079A circle is a cons (circle . ((x0 . y0) . r)) specifying the center
3080and the radius of the circle; r may be a float or integer.
3081A polygon is a cons (poly . [x0 y0 x1 y1 ...]) where each pair in the
3082vector describes one corner in the polygon.
3083
3084When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
3085PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
3086property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
3087a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
3088it is over the hot-spot. See the variable 'void-area-text-pointer'
3089for possible pointer shapes.
3090
3091When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
3092an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
3093mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
3094
5f6eef94
KS
3095** Mouse event enhancements:
3096
a775dff4 3097+++
5f6eef94
KS
3098*** Mouse clicks on fringes now generates left-fringe or right-fringes
3099events, rather than a text area click event.
3100
a775dff4 3101+++
05faee07
KS
3102*** Mouse clicks in the left and right marginal areas now includes a
3103sensible buffer position corresponding to the first character in the
3104corresponding text row.
3105
a775dff4 3106+++
05faee07
KS
3107*** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
3108
5f6eef94
KS
3109+++
3110*** Mouse events now includes buffer position for all event types.
3111
3112+++
3113*** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
3114
5f6eef94 3115+++
3999c705 3116*** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
5f6eef94
KS
3117text area).
3118
3119+++
3120*** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types.
3121
3122+++
3123*** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns actual glyph coordinates.
3124
d46aeafc
KS
3125+++
3126*** Mouse events may now include image object in addition to string object.
3127
3128+++
3129*** Mouse events include relative x and y pixel coordinates relative to
d18473b9 3130the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
d46aeafc 3131
05faee07
KS
3132+++
3133*** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
3134(image or character) clicked on.
3135
3136+++
3137*** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', and
3138'posn-object-width-height' return the image or string object of a mouse
3139click, the x and y pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner
3140of that object, and the total width and height of that object.
d46aeafc 3141
a775dff4 3142+++
5f6eef94
KS
3143** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
3144one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
3145contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
3146changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
3147forcing an explicit window update.
3148
3149** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
3150debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
3151
76bf15e9
LT
3152+++
3153** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
3154the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
3155SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
3156nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
3157empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
3158
06a49fc1
LT
3159+++
3160** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
3161
c6177909
LT
3162+++
3163** If optional third argument APPEND to `add-to-list' is non-nil, a
3164new element gets added at the end of the list instead of at the
3165beginning. This change actually occurred in Emacs-21.1, but was not
3166documented.
3167
01b70437
DL
3168** Major modes can define `eldoc-print-current-symbol-info-function'
3169locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
3170the language.
3171
d18473b9 3172---
4a29bad2
DL
3173** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
3174the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
3175parts, e.g. utf-16.
3176
f6537e03 3177+++
0e7d7aae
RS
3178** The argument to forward-word, backward-word, forward-to-indentation
3179and backward-to-indentation is now optional, and defaults to 1.
3180
f6537e03
RS
3181+++
3182** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
3183to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
3184a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
3185
3186Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
3187does that, this value may not be accurate.
3188
51a8b435 3189+++
c6de56a0
RS
3190** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
3191actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
3192divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
3193the mode line.
3194
51a8b435 3195+++
c6de56a0
RS
3196** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
3197return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
3198
51a8b435 3199+++
bf078377
SM
3200** The kill-buffer-hook is now permanent-local.
3201
51a8b435
RS
3202+++
3203** `select-window' takes an optional second argument `norecord', like
3204`switch-to-buffer'.
9c0fb8b9 3205
51a8b435
RS
3206+++
3207** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
3208selected window without impacting the order of buffer-list.
3209
3210+++
3211** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
3212text-properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
3213works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
9c0fb8b9 3214
51a8b435 3215+++
c64a682c
SM
3216** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
3217in the keymap.
3218
51a8b435 3219---
c64a682c
SM
3220** VC changes for backends:
3221*** (vc-switches BACKEND OPERATION) is a new function for use by backends.
3222*** The new `find-version' backend function replaces the `destfile'
3223parameter of the `checkout' backend function.
3224Old code still works thanks to a default `find-version' behavior that
3225uses the old `destfile' parameter.
3226
51a8b435 3227+++
c6de56a0
RS
3228** The new macro dynamic-completion-table supports using functions
3229as a dynamic completion table.
3230
3231 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
3232
3233FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
3234and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
3235completions. This alist may be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
3236can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
3237minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
3238entered. dynamic-completion-table then computes the completion.
3239
51a8b435 3240+++
c6de56a0
RS
3241** The new macro lazy-completion-table initializes a variable
3242as a lazy completion table.
3243
3244 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN &rest ARGS)
3245
3246If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
3247as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with arguments
3248ARGS. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR. If
3249completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
3250from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
3251`lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
3252
51a8b435 3253+++
5ceea398
RS
3254** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
3255
e50886d3
RS
3256+++
3257** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
5ceea398
RS
3258for all (existing and future) frames.
3259
51a8b435 3260+++
5ceea398 3261** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
052797a7 3262
51a8b435 3263+++
052797a7
SM
3264** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
3265
51a8b435 3266+++
052797a7
SM
3267** The macro `with-syntax-table' does not copy the table any more.
3268
e50886d3 3269+++
211a9f6b
KH
3270** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
3271(or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
87a4ed45 3272'((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
211a9f6b
KH
3273point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
3274SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
3275
e50886d3 3276+++
eb67c5d6
RS
3277** The function `number-sequence' returns a list of equally-separated
3278numbers. For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9).
3279By default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different separation
3280as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns (1.5 3.5 5.5).
3281
e50886d3 3282+++
5d0ab731 3283** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
b0ada147
RS
3284specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
3285many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
3286`file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
3287
e50886d3 3288---
32d0a9dc
KH
3289** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
3290the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
3291
e50886d3 3292+++
63a08a73 3293** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character,
b23375aa
KS
3294unless it is followed by a `-' in a character constant (e.g. ?\s-A),
3295in which case it is still interpreted as the super modifier.
3296In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
3297
e50886d3 3298+++
ce4254bd
KH
3299** New function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the multibyteness
3300of a string given to a process's filter.
3301
e50886d3 3302+++
ce4254bd
KH
3303** New function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns t if
3304a string given to a process's filter is multibyte.
3305
e50886d3 3306+++
ce4254bd
KH
3307** A filter function of a process is called with a multibyte string if
3308the filter's multibyteness is t. That multibyteness is decided by the
3309value of `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is
3310created and can be changed later by `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
3311
e50886d3 3312+++
ce4254bd
KH
3313** If a process's coding system is raw-text or no-conversion and its
3314buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
3315to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
3316Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
4e07258f 3317which was not compatible with the behavior of file reading.
ce4254bd 3318
e50886d3 3319+++
b08d5f59
KH
3320** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
3321multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
3322
e50886d3 3323+++
6eed9bed
DL
3324** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
3325on garbage collection.
3326
e50886d3 3327+++
b08d5f59
KH
3328** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
3329it is read from a file without decoding.
b6c2aa59 3330
e50886d3
RS
3331+++
3332** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
175573ac 3333
e50886d3 3334+++
2155ecf3
RS
3335** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
3336of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
3337by calling `select-window'.
3338
e50886d3 3339---
2155ecf3
RS
3340** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
3341if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
3342into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
3343need to have a name.
3344
f08830d2
DL
3345** Byte compiler changes:
3346
e50886d3 3347---
f08830d2
DL
3348*** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
3349helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
3350Emacs and XEmacs and may sometimes make the result significantly more
3351efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
3352generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
3353you anything.
3354
e50886d3 3355+++
f08830d2
DL
3356*** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
3357simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
3358useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
3359Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
3360forms:
3361
3362 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
3363 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
3364
3365In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
3366won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
3367second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
3368unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
3369macro expansion), but such tests may be nested. Note that `when' and
3370`unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
c60ee5e7 3371
e50886d3
RS
3372+++
3373*** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
3374inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
3375
3376+++
3377** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
3378is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
3379be inserted is translated through it.
a4ac5b17 3380
9252f7bc
RS
3381+++
3382** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
a4ac5b17 3383which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
9252f7bc
RS
3384current file redefined it).
3385
56011a8c
RS
3386+++
3387** `load-history' now records (defun . FUNNAME) when a function is
3388defined. For a variable, it records just the variable name.
3389
e50886d3 3390+++
d2d70cb6
JY
3391** New Lisp library testcover.el works with edebug to help you determine
3392whether you've tested all your Lisp code. Function testcover-start
3393instruments all functions in a given file. Then test your code. Function
3394testcover-mark-all adds overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to
3395show where coverage is lacking. Command testcover-next-mark (bind it to
3396a key!) will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
3397
3398*** Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely evaluated;
3399a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same value. The red
3400splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly complete their evaluation,
3401such as `error'. The brown splotches are skipped for forms that are expected
3402to always evaluate to the same value, such as (setq x 14).
3403
3404*** For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to help
9f8a930d
JY
3405out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a red splotch.
3406It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does return. The macro 1value
3407suppresses a brown splotch for its argument. This macro is a no-op except
3408during test-coverage -- then it signals an error if the argument actually
3409returns differing values.
d2d70cb6 3410
9cc1eb89 3411+++
d2d70cb6
JY
3412** New function unsafep returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly
3413do anything dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be
3414unsafe (calls dangerous function, alters global variable, etc).
3415
e50886d3
RS
3416+++
3417** The new variable `print-continuous-numbering', when non-nil, says
3418that successive calls to print functions should use the same
3419numberings for circular structure references. This is only relevant
3420when `print-circle' is non-nil.
3421
3422When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
3423also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
3116d142 3424
e50886d3 3425+++
7c3cb37d
RS
3426** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
3427the scroll-bar-width frame parameter value is nil.
3428
e50886d3 3429+++
7c3cb37d
RS
3430** The new function copy-abbrev-table returns a new abbrev table that
3431is a copy of a given abbrev table.
3432
21beb82f 3433+++
add89676
RS
3434** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
3435It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
21beb82f 3436can start with this line:
add89676
RS
3437
3438 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
3439
a775dff4 3440+++
3bd7a6ed
TTN
3441** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
3442Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
3443appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
3444
3445 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
3446
3447Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
3448in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
3449
e50886d3 3450+++
02ce3e80
SM
3451** A function's docstring can now hold the function's usage info on
3452its last line. It should match the regexp "\n\n(fn.*)\\'".
3453
e50886d3 3454---
fc2938d1
DL
3455** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
3456hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
3457
e50886d3 3458+++
3bcd2096
JPW
3459** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional buffer
3460argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted it defaults to
3461the current buffer.
79fab26b 3462
c5e0561f 3463+++
56592beb
RS
3464** There is a new Warnings facility; see the functions `warn'
3465and `display-warning'.
3466
e50886d3 3467+++
a7bd9dc7
SM
3468** The functions all-completions and try-completion now accept lists
3469of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
3470and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
b686dd59
KS
3471exported to Lisp. The keys in alists and hash tables may be either
3472strings or symbols, which are automatically converted with to strings.
a7bd9dc7 3473
e50886d3 3474---
1c6576ab
RS
3475** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
3476much pure storage it will approximately need.
3477
e50886d3 3478+++
2b6bb1f2
RS
3479** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
3480to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
3481for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
3482file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
3483
e50886d3 3484---
cc305a60
RS
3485** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
3486of one coding system from another coding system.
3487
661e85c1 3488+++
2b6bb1f2
RS
3489** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
3490are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
3491specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
3492such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
3493needed.
3494
c5e0561f 3495---
2b6bb1f2
RS
3496** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
3497that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
3498appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
3499is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
3500ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
3501with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
3502
3503If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
3504confirmation as before.
3505
c5e0561f 3506+++
6f8968c8 3507** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
2b6bb1f2 3508
6f8968c8
KS
3509The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
3510can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
3511frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
3512Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
2b6bb1f2 3513
6f8968c8
KS
3514The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
3515specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
3516integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
3517between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
3518specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
3519only the left fringe gets the specified width).
2b6bb1f2
RS
3520
3521Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
3522width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
3523of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
3524fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
3525
c5e0561f 3526+++
6f8968c8
KS
3527** Per-window fringes settings
3528
3529Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and position
3530settings.
3531
3532To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
3533variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
3534`set-window-fringes'.
3535
3536To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
3537are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
3538or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
3539`fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
3540
3541The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
3542settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
3543`fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
3544displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
3545an update of the display margins.
3546
f6537e03 3547+++
6f8968c8
KS
3548** Per-window vertical scroll-bar settings
3549
3550Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
3551controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
3552
3553To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
3554variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
3555`set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
3556used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
3557`scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
3558the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
3559of the display margins.
3560
c5e0561f 3561+++
6f8968c8
KS
3562** The function `set-window-buffer' now has an optional third argument
3563KEEP-MARGINS which will preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
3564and scroll-bar settings if non-nil.
3565
f2aa473a 3566+++
2d586478 3567** Renamed hooks to better follow the naming convention:
2881ae98
SM
3568find-file-hooks to find-file-hook,
3569find-file-not-found-hooks to find-file-not-found-functions,
3570write-file-hooks to write-file-functions,
2d586478
SM
3571write-contents-hooks to write-contents-functions,
3572x-lost-selection-hooks to x-lost-selection-functions,
3573x-sent-selection-hooks to x-sent-selection-functions.
2881ae98
SM
3574Marked local-write-file-hooks as obsolete (use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook').
3575
c5e0561f 3576+++
c60ee5e7 3577** The new variable `delete-frame-functions' replaces `delete-frame-hook'.
7757cdaf
JPW
3578It was renamed to follow the naming conventions for abnormal hooks. The old
3579name remains available as an alias, but has been marked obsolete.
3580
c5e0561f 3581+++
02f20f98
KS
3582** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
3583specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
3584new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
3585while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
3586variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
3587
c5e0561f 3588---
02f20f98
KS
3589** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by lisp code
3590to override the internal read-file-name function.
3591
94966e2b
JPW
3592
3593** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
3594whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
3595`read-file-name' function.
3596
c5e0561f 3597+++
21b6d966
KS
3598** The new function `read-directory-name' can be used instead of
3599`read-file-name' to read a directory name; when used, completion
3600will only show directories.
3601
c5e0561f 3602+++
af7272b1
RS
3603** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
3604non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
3605its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
261b01c6 3606The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
af7272b1 3607
c5e0561f 3608---
af7272b1
RS
3609** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
3610now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
3611(require 'cl) when loaded.
3612
c5e0561f 3613+++
ee9e0c25
GM
3614** The `defmacro' form may contain declarations specifying how to
3615indent the macro in Lisp mode and how to debug it with Edebug. The
3616syntax of defmacro has been extended to
3617
3618 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3619
3620DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3621declaration specifiers supported are:
3622
3623(indent INDENT)
3624 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3625
3626(edebug DEBUG)
3627 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3628 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro.
3629
0e7d7aae 3630+++
93607efd
KS
3631** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
3632
3633This is an alternative to using defadvice or substitute-key-definition
dfd67a62 3634to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
93607efd
KS
3635binding and lookup functionality.
3636
3637When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
3638remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
3639original command.
3640
3641Example:
3642Suppose that minor mode my-mode has defined the commands
3643my-kill-line and my-kill-word, and it wants C-k (and any other key
3644bound to kill-line) to run the command my-kill-line instead of
3645kill-line, and likewise it wants to run my-kill-word instead of
3646kill-word.
3647
3648Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
3649command remapping allows you to directly map kill-line into
3650my-kill-line and kill-word into my-kill-word through the minor mode
3651map using define-key:
3652
a8959ac2
KS
3653 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
3654 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
93607efd
KS
3655
3656Now, when my-mode is enabled, and the user enters C-k or M-d,
3657the commands my-kill-line and my-kill-word are run.
3658
3659Notice that only one level of remapping is supported. In the above
3660example, this means that if my-kill-line is remapped to other-kill,
3661then C-k still runs my-kill-line.
3662
3663The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
3664
a8959ac2
KS
3665- Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
3666 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
3667 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
3668 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
93607efd 3669
a84db054
KS
3670- The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
3671 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
93607efd
KS
3672
3673- key-binding now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
a8959ac2 3674 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
93607efd
KS
3675
3676- where-is-internal now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
3677 kill-line if my-mode is enabled), and the actual key binding for
3678 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
3679 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
3680 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns C-k for kill-line and
3681 <kill-line> for my-kill-line).
3682
3683- The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
3684 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
3685 command was not remapped.
3686
0e7d7aae 3687+++
3f21fb3a
KS
3688** New variable emulation-mode-map-alists.
3689
3690Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
3691keymap alist separate from minor-mode-map-alist by adding their keymap
3692alist to this list.
3693
f6537e03 3694+++
108eaabb
RS
3695** Atomic change groups.
3696
3697To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3698they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3699around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3700
3701 (atomic-change-group
3702 (insert foo)
3703 (delete-region x y))
3704
3705If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3706`atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3707were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3708on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3709
3710If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3711lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3712
3713To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3714Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3715This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3716the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3717
3718Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3719group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3720do this.
3721
3722After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3723either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3724`accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3725call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3726
3727You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3728finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3729`unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3730(This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3731`activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3732group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3733twice.
3734
3735To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3736for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3737returned values, like this:
3738
3739 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3740 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3741
3742You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3743to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3744`accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3745
3746Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3747would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3748will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3749change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3750finished.
3751
f17c0a19
CW
3752+++
3753** New variable char-property-alias-alist.
3754
3755This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
3756properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
3757although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
3758to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
3759
0e7d7aae 3760+++
f17c0a19
CW
3761** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
3762
3763This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
3764M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
3765property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
3766new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
3767
0e7d7aae 3768+++
d9f7eb77
RS
3769** New function remove-list-of-text-properties.
3770
3771The new function `remove-list-of-text-properties' is almost the same
3772as `remove-text-properties'. The only difference is that it takes
3773a list of property names as argument rather than a property list.
3774
0e7d7aae 3775+++
18232c16 3776** New function insert-for-yank.
d278091b 3777
18232c16
KS
3778This function normally works like `insert' but removes the text
3779properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list. However, if the
3780inserted text has a `yank-handler' text property on the first
3781character of the string, the insertion of the text may be modified in
3782a number of ways. See the description of `yank-handler' below.
3783
0e7d7aae 3784+++
18232c16
KS
3785** New function insert-buffer-substring-as-yank.
3786
3787This function works like `insert-buffer-substring', but removes the
3788text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list.
d278091b 3789
0e7d7aae 3790+++
d278091b
KS
3791** New function insert-buffer-substring-no-properties.
3792
18232c16
KS
3793This function is like insert-buffer-substring, but removes all
3794text properties from the inserted substring.
3795
0e7d7aae 3796+++
18232c16
KS
3797** New `yank-handler' text property may be used to control how
3798previously killed text on the kill-ring is reinserted.
3799
0e7d7aae 3800The value of the yank-handler property must be a list with one to four
18232c16 3801elements with the following format:
a6098104 3802 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
18232c16
KS
3803
3804The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
3805the first character on its string argument (typically the first
3806element on the kill-ring). If a yank-handler property is found,
4e07258f 3807the normal behavior of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
18232c16
KS
3808
3809 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
3810to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
3811 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
3812passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
3813`yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
3814rectangle.
3815 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
3816yank-excluded-properties is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
3817responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
3818if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
3819 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
3820by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
c60ee5e7 3821called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
18232c16 3822FUNCTION may set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
18232c16 3823
a775dff4 3824+++
0e7d7aae
RS
3825*** The functions kill-new, kill-append, and kill-region now have an
3826optional argument to specify the yank-handler text property to put on
3827the killed text.
18232c16 3828
a775dff4 3829+++
18232c16
KS
3830*** The function yank-pop will now use a non-nil value of the variable
3831`yank-undo-function' (instead of delete-region) to undo the previous
3832yank or yank-pop command (or a call to insert-for-yank). The function
3833insert-for-yank automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
3834element of the string argument's yank-handler text property if present.
3835
f6537e03 3836+++
11ef2a3b
MB
3837** New function display-supports-face-attributes-p may be used to test
3838whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
3839
3840A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
3841specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
3842defined with defface.
3843
7e07a66d
MB
3844** The function face-differs-from-default-p now truly checks whether the
3845given face displays differently from the default face or not (previously
3846it did only a very cursory check).
3847
f6537e03 3848+++
3d619ea1
MB
3849** face-attribute, face-foreground, face-background, and face-stipple now
3850accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how face
3851inheritance is used when determining the value of a face attribute.
3852
f6537e03 3853+++
3d619ea1
MB
3854** New functions face-attribute-relative-p and merge-face-attribute
3855help with handling relative face attributes.
3856
a0a23346
MB
3857** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face-list is reversed.
3858If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
3859faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous releases
3860of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made so that
3861:inherit face-lists operate identically to face-lists in text `face'
3862properties.
3863
f6537e03 3864+++
15aeeda5
KS
3865** Enhancements to process support
3866
3867*** Function list-processes now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
3868only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set are listed.
3869
3870*** New set-process-query-on-exit-flag and process-query-on-exit-flag
3871functions. The existing process-kill-without-query function is still
3872supported, but new code should use the new functions.
3873
3874*** Function signal-process now accepts a process object or process
3875name in addition to a process id to identify the signalled process.
3876
e519464c 3877*** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
c60ee5e7 3878maintain process state and other per-process related information.
e519464c
KS
3879
3880The new functions process-get and process-put are used to access, add,
3881and modify elements on this property list.
3882
3883The new low-level functions process-plist and set-process-plist are
3884used to access and replace the entire property list of a process.
3885
101c421e
KS
3886*** Function accept-process-output now has an optional fourth arg
3887`just-this-one'. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
3888is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
3889integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
3890recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
3891speech synthesis.
3892
a775dff4 3893---
31e0fbdd
KS
3894*** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
3895
3896On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
3897output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
4e07258f 3898very poor performance. This behavior can be remedied to some extent
31e0fbdd
KS
3899by setting the new variable process-adaptive-read-buffering to a
3900non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
3901from such processes, to allowing them to produce more output before
3902emacs tries to read it.
3903
f6537e03 3904+++
fd13a3cc 3905** Enhanced networking support.
1e892206 3906
fd13a3cc
KS
3907*** There is a new `make-network-process' function which supports
3908opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
3909create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
1e892206 3910
fd13a3cc 3911- A server is started using :server t arg.
60a501d7 3912- Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
fd13a3cc
KS
3913- A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
3914- Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
3915- Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
e519464c
KS
3916- The process' property list may be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
3917 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
3918 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
1e892206 3919
60a501d7
KS
3920To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
3921 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
3922
fd13a3cc
KS
3923*** Original open-network-stream is now emulated using make-network-process.
3924
3925*** New function open-network-stream-nowait.
3926
3927This function initiates a non-blocking connect and returns immediately
8e9e520b
KS
3928without waiting for the connection to be established. It takes the
3929filter and sentinel functions as arguments; when the non-blocking
3930connect completes, the sentinel is called with a status string
3931matching "open" or "failed".
fd13a3cc
KS
3932
3933*** New function open-network-stream-server.
8e9e520b
KS
3934
3935This function creates a network server process for a TCP service.
3936When a client connects to the specified service, a new subprocess
3937is created to handle the new connection, and the sentinel function
3938is called for the new process.
fd13a3cc
KS
3939
3940*** New functions process-datagram-address and set-process-datagram-address.
8e9e520b
KS
3941
3942These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
3943and set the current address of the remote partner.
fd13a3cc 3944
4e5cdb4f 3945*** New function format-network-address.
8e9e520b
KS
3946
3947This function reformats the lisp representation of a network address
3948to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
3949number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
3950printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
3951string for other formatting options.
4e5cdb4f 3952
fd13a3cc
KS
3953*** By default, the function process-contact still returns (HOST SERVICE)
3954for a network process. Using the new optional KEY arg, the complete list
3955of network process properties or a specific property can be selected.
3956
3957Using :local and :remote as the KEY, the address of the local or
3958remote end-point is returned. An Inet address is represented as a 5
3959element vector, where the first 4 elements contain the IP address and
3960the fifth is the port number.
3961
3962*** Network processes can now be stopped and restarted with
3963`stop-process' and `continue-process'. For a server process, no
3964connections are accepted in the stopped state. For a client process,
3965no input is received in the stopped state.
3966
205f1dde
KS
3967*** New function network-interface-list.
3968
3969This function returns a list of network interface names and their
3970current network addresses.
3971
0c4da023 3972*** New function network-interface-info.
205f1dde
KS
3973
3974This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
3975status, and other information about a specific network interface.
3976
f6537e03 3977+++
6ba3d6bc
CW
3978** New function copy-tree.
3979
f6537e03 3980+++
9ade4a7d
RS
3981** New function substring-no-properties.
3982
f6537e03 3983+++
3bdb7f80
KS
3984** New function minibuffer-selected-window.
3985
f6537e03 3986+++
4e3dd7cf
MB
3987** New function `call-process-shell-command'.
3988
a775dff4 3989+++
213856ba
KG
3990** New function `process-file'.
3991
3992This is similar to `call-process', but obeys file handlers. The file
3993handler is chosen based on default-directory.
3994
f6537e03 3995---
f6078b98
RS
3996** The dummy function keys made by easymenu
3997are now always lower case. If you specify the
3998menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
3999as the "key" bound by that key binding.
4000
4001This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for
4002the bindings that were made with easymenu.
4003
0e7d7aae 4004+++
f6078b98
RS
4005** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional
4006argument. If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks
4007for a function that could be called with `call-interactively',
4008and does not return t for keyboard macros.
4009
f6537e03 4010---
2a1e884e
RS
4011** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
4012buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
4013
4014It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
4015and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
4016buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
4017commands.
4018
4019This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
4020sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
4021SQL buffer.
4022
4023(add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
4024 (function (lambda ()
4025 (master-mode t)
4026 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
4027(add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
4028 (function (lambda ()
4029 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
4030
f6537e03 4031+++
596d02bc
RS
4032** File local variables.
4033
4034A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
4035properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
4036
d33c4505
RS
4037+++
4038** New function window-body-height.
4039
4040This is like window-height but does not count the mode line
4041or the header line.
4042
0e7d7aae 4043+++
21b6d966
KS
4044** New function format-mode-line.
4045
4046This returns the mode-line or header-line of the selected (or a
f4d7915c 4047specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
21b6d966 4048
9f89426b
KS
4049+++
4050** New function safe-plist-get.
4051
4052This function is like plist-get, but never signals an error for
4053a malformed property list.
4054
0e7d7aae 4055+++
9356fe5a
RS
4056** New functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put'.
4057
4058These functions are like `plist-get' and `plist-put' except that they
4059compare the property name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
4060
0e7d7aae 4061+++
4f4fada2
RS
4062** New function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu'
4063
9252f7bc 4064The `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' must not be used (as previously
4f4fada2
RS
4065recommended) for making entries in the tool bar for local keymaps.
4066Instead, use the function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu', which lets
4067you specify the map to use as an argument.
4068
c4f59bcf
EZ
4069+++
4070** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
4071
4072When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
4073angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
4074equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
4075
75e20bec
RS
4076+++
4077** You can now make a window as short as one line.
4078
4079A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
4080line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
4081`header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
4082cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
4083variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
4084
e0c124ce
EZ
4085+++
4086** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
4087for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
4088number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
4089Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
4090
bc3b02f9
LK
4091+++
4092** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
4093used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
4094
5df034de
LK
4095+++
4096** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
4097to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
4098line.
4099
1c6576ab
RS
4100---
4101** Indentation of simple and extended loop forms has been added to the
4102cl-indent package. The new user options
4103`lisp-loop-keyword-indentation', `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and
4104`lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can be used to customize the
4105indentation of keywords and forms in loop forms.
4106
4107---
4108** Indentation of backquoted forms has been made customizable in the
4109cl-indent package. See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
4110
1ae7cf5e 4111+++
aaddfb29
RS
4112** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
4113
4114Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
4115from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
4116buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
4117now:
4118
41191. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
4120
41212. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
4122the time it takes to convert the format.
4123
41243. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
4125wasteful.
4126
1ae7cf5e 4127+++
edde72f6
RS
4128** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
4129over minor mode keymaps.
4130
1ae7cf5e 4131+++
0065bb74
RS
4132** A hex escape in a string forces the string to be multibyte.
4133An octal escape makes it unibyte.
4134
1ae7cf5e 4135+++
5ceea398
RS
4136** At the end of a command, point moves out from within invisible
4137text, in the same way it moves out from within text covered by an
4138image or composition property.
4139
c64a682c
SM
4140This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
4141This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
4142unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
4143(including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
4144post-command-hook and thus does not care about intermediate states.
5d0ab731 4145
51a8b435 4146+++
bf36a6d3
MB
4147** field-beginning and field-end now accept an additional optional
4148argument, LIMIT.
4e02881b 4149
ef8aee62 4150+++
1b8c66fe
RS
4151** define-abbrev now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG. If
4152non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means that
4153it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the abbrevs.
4154Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always specify this
4155flag.
4156
51a8b435 4157---
c95eaa61
PJ
4158** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
4159
51a8b435 4160---
c95eaa61
PJ
4161** The function insert-string is now obsolete.
4162
51a8b435 4163---
111ed14e
SM
4164** The precedence of file-name-handlers has been changed.
4165Instead of blindly choosing the first handler that matches,
4166find-file-name-handler now gives precedence to a file-name handler
4167that matches near the end of the file name. More specifically, the
4168handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen.
4169In case of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
4170
51a8b435 4171---
cfaa4a1b 4172** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
59b59892
SM
4173Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
4174bindings of the parent keymap.
cfaa4a1b 4175
51a8b435 4176---
f67cc62e
SM
4177** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
4178If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
4179(see jit-lock-defer-contextually), then all of that text will
4180be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
4181depends on text several lines further down (and when font-lock-multiline
4182is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
4183
4184 s{
4185 foo
4186 }{
4187 bar
4188 }e
4189
4190Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
4191text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a jit-lock-defer-multiline
4192property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
4193refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
4194
51a8b435 4195---
6710ea06 4196** describe-vector now takes a second argument `describer' which is
fbe51115 4197called to print the entries' values. It defaults to `princ'.
6710ea06 4198
a775dff4 4199+++
16927a56 4200** defcustom and other custom declarations now use a default group
d18473b9 4201(the last prior group defined in the same file) when no :group was given.
16927a56 4202
51a8b435 4203+++
16927a56
SM
4204** emacsserver now runs pre-command-hook and post-command-hook when
4205it receives a request from emacsclient.
4206
51a8b435 4207---
8727d588
RS
4208** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
4209Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
4210than 3 levels of nesting.
4211
51a8b435 4212---
1c1d3d69
RS
4213** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
4214property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
4215it in that buffer.
4216
51a8b435 4217---
ae4000f1 4218** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
1ff74324 4219properties from surrounding text.
1c1d3d69 4220
bcdf2143 4221+++
d1b2b8cc
RS
4222** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
4223element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
4224accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
bcdf2143 4225
51a8b435 4226+++
830047fd
RS
4227** New function `buffer-local-value'.
4228
830047fd
RS
4229This function returns the buffer-local binding of VARIABLE (a symbol)
4230in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not have a buffer-local binding in
4231buffer BUFFER, it returns the default value of VARIABLE instead.
6c0b2643 4232
51a8b435 4233---
8e8223e2
SM
4234** New function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
4235that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
4236clone to the other.
4237
51a8b435 4238+++
8e8223e2
SM
4239** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
4240*** the FACENAME returned in font-lock-keywords can be a list
d390f4aa 4241of the form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set
8e8223e2
SM
4242other properties than `face'.
4243*** font-lock-extra-managed-props can be set to make sure those extra
4244properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
4245
51a8b435 4246---
0df7a0b6
EZ
4247** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
4248or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
51a8b435
RS
4249`defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
4250the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
4251directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
0df7a0b6 4252
51a8b435 4253+++
8e8223e2
SM
4254** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
4255are used by define-derived-mode to make sure the mode hook for the
4256parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
4257
51a8b435 4258+++
0ec6b206
SM
4259** define-minor-mode now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
4260and simply passes them to defcustom, if applicable.
4261
51a8b435 4262+++
7c3cb37d
RS
4263** define-derived-mode by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
4264It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
4265
a7bd9dc7 4266+++
8e8223e2
SM
4267** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
4268to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
7bea57c9 4269and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
8e8223e2 4270
202082d3
EZ
4271+++
4272** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
4273ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
4274`.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
4275
51a8b435 4276+++
63ca0a6e
GM
4277** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
4278user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
4279accepts a float as UID parameter.
4280
51a8b435 4281---
30de4b24
SM
4282** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
4283
51a8b435 4284+++
30de4b24
SM
4285** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in elisp files is now obeyed.
4286
51a8b435 4287+++
1c6576ab
RS
4288** The Emacs Lisp byte-compiler now displays the actual line and
4289character position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form
4290of its warning and error messages have been brought more in line with
4291the output of other GNU tools.
4292
51a8b435 4293+++
026f408d
SM
4294** New functions `keymap-prompt' and `current-active-maps'.
4295
51a8b435 4296---
026f408d
SM
4297** New function `describe-buffer-bindings'.
4298
51a8b435 4299+++
026f408d
SM
4300** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
4301searching for an executable resp. an elisp file.
4302
51a8b435 4303+++
cb8d4d07 4304** Variable aliases have been implemented:
6c0b2643 4305
51a8b435 4306*** defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
6c0b2643 4307
3fdb4c50
JB
4308This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
4309symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
4310returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
4311changes the value of BASE-VAR.
6c0b2643 4312
32ebbc3a
JB
4313DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
4314the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
4315
51a8b435 4316*** indirect-variable VARIABLE
6c0b2643
GM
4317
4318This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
4319of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
4320defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
4321
4322It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
4323variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
4324
51a8b435 4325+++
6c0b2643
GM
4326** Functions from `post-gc-hook' are run at the end of garbage
4327collection. The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
4328
51a8b435 4329+++
ace64e0a
GM
4330** If the second argument to `copy-file' is the name of a directory,
4331the file is copied to that directory instead of signaling an error.
4332
51a8b435 4333+++
123ac55e 4334** The variables most-positive-fixnum and most-negative-fixnum
51a8b435 4335hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
123ac55e 4336
51a8b435 4337---
0b559506
JR
4338** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
4339The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
4340formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
4341
a775dff4 4342---
51a8b435
RS
4343** Functions y-or-n-p, read-char, read-key-sequence and the like, that
4344display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
6b3daede
GM
4345using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
4346
c94472fc
JD
4347** New function x-send-client-message sends a client message when
4348running under X.
4349
a775dff4 4350+++
f24485f1 4351** Arguments for remove-overlays are now optional, so that you can remove
e71caa4e 4352all overlays in the buffer by just calling (remove-overlay).
f24485f1 4353
30de4b24
SM
4354** New packages:
4355
71c88486
NR
4356*** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
4357GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
4358there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
4359state of your program. It separates the input/output of your program from
f2afecda
NR
4360that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
4361Emacs 21 such as the display margin for breakpoints, and the toolbar.
71c88486
NR
4362
4363Use M-x gdba to start GDB-UI.
4364
30de4b24
SM
4365*** The new package syntax.el provides an efficient way to find the
4366current syntactic context (as returned by parse-partial-sexp).
4367
ffe5000a
KS
4368*** The new package bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
4369binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
4370data structures.
4371
e95768c5 4372*** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
c494f663
CW
4373This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
4374
4e3dd7cf
MB
4375*** The new package button.el implements simple and fast `clickable buttons'
4376in emacs buffers. `buttons' are much lighter-weight than the `widgets'
4377implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that doesn't
4378require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for such things
4379as help and apropos buffers.
4380
6c0b2643 4381\f
71c88486
NR
4382* Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
4383
4384** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
4385been added.
4386
4387\f
4388* Changes in Emacs 21.3
4389
4390** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
4391with Custom.
4392
4393** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
2d2ff530 4394as mule-utf-8.
71c88486
NR
4395
4396** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
4397in UTF-8 locales).
4398
4399** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
4400different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
4401Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
4402and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
4403between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
4404(e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
4405`unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
4406`unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
4407it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
4408By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
4409
4410** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
4411`selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
4412
4413If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
4414compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
4415compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
4e07258f 4416text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually
71c88486
NR
4417contrary to the compound text specification.
4418
4419\f
4420* Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
4421
4422** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
4423
4424** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
4425
4426\f
4427* Changes in Emacs 21.2
4428
4429** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
4430
4431X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
4432compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
4433list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
4434selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
4435compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
4436
4437** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
4438were changed.
4439
4440** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
4441now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
4442
4443** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
4444initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
4445instead of using default-major-mode.
4446
4447** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
4448like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
4449as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
4450(the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
4451visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
4452is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
4453to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
4454
4455This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
4456NEWS.
4457
4458\f
4459* Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
4460
4461** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
4462have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
4463and the latter now controls scrolling down.
4464
4465** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
4466be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
4467
4468\f
251584f3
DL
4469* Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
4470
889be0a1
DL
4471See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
4472fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
4473charsets in this release.
4474
f4988be7
GM
4475** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
4476
424d8b44
DL
4477** Support for LynxOS has been added.
4478
1fa28578 4479** There are new configure options associated with the support for
163ea954
RS
4480images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
4481to list them.
6344985d 4482
5ed8d5af 4483** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
60dd7e0e 4484support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
8628686a
DL
4485maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
4486build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
4487necessary changes to unexec.
f4988be7 4488
efeb796b
EZ
4489** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
4490Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
4491
4492** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
4493Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
4494
4495** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
4496the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
d9c9b920 4497
e90813b8 4498** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
a7c13351 4499all of the new display features described below. The port currently
d69aa2e3
EZ
4500lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
4501"Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
4502description of aspects specific to the Mac.
d9c9b920 4503
efeb796b
EZ
4504** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
4505new display features described below.
4506
05197f40 4507\f
1fa28578
GM
4508* Changes in Emacs 21.1
4509
1e7db2e9
GM
4510** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
4511
4512The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
4513Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
4514oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
4515of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
4516the text.
4517
4518** Emacs has a new face implementation.
4519
4520The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
4521font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
4522height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
4523These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
4524specify a font.
4525
4526Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
4527These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
4528under Lisp changes, below.
4529
4530** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
4531
4532Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
4533Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
4534the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
4535italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
4536Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
4537attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
4538on terminals.
4539
4540The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
4541supported on character terminals.
4542
efeb796b
EZ
4543Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
4544the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
4545same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
4546a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
4547
1e7db2e9
GM
4548** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
4549
efeb796b
EZ
4550** Sound support
4551
4552Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
4553driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
4554supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
c8682017
EZ
4555You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
4556sound support.
efeb796b 4557
1e7db2e9
GM
4558** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
4559
4560If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
4561longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
4562is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
4563minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
4564
4565- User option: max-mini-window-height
4566
4567Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
4568fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
4569specifies a number of lines.
4570
4571Default is 0.25.
4572
4573- User option: resize-mini-windows
4574
4575How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
4576resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
4577grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
4578again.
4579
4580Default is `grow-only'.
4581
4582** LessTif support.
4583
4584Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
a04c6760 4585<http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
1e7db2e9
GM
4586
4587** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
4588
4589When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
4590from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
4591non-nil.
4592
8f80abd8
EZ
4593** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
4594
4595When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
4596now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
4597file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
4598
1e7db2e9
GM
4599** Toolkit scroll bars.
4600
4601Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
4602LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
4603configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
4604bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
4605bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
4606Emacs.
4607
4608When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
4609Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
4610Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
4611Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
4612define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
4613`s/freebsd.h' as an example.
4614
4615Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
4616a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
4617directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
4618different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
4619system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
4620add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
4621
4622The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
4623`float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
4624This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
3593c177 4625imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
1e7db2e9
GM
4626Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
4627
1e7db2e9
GM
4628** Tool bar support.
4629
4630Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
4631of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
4632changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
4633displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
4634if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
4635icons will be used.
4636
4637To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
70fae708 4638for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
1e7db2e9 4639
1e7db2e9
GM
4640** Tooltips.
4641
4642Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
4643mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
4644turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
4645
4646Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
4647variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
4648the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
4649tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
4650
efeb796b
EZ
4651** Automatic Hscrolling
4652
4653Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
4654`automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
4655customized.
4656
4657If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
4658scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
4659for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
4660the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
4661to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
4662
1e7db2e9
GM
4663** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
4664of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
4665solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
ab9c49cf 4666`cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
1e7db2e9 4667cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
2018166d 4668non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
1e7db2e9
GM
4669
4670** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
4671truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
4672foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
4673customizing face `fringe'.
4674
4675** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
4676You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
4677In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
4678appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
4679occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
4680the window to be partially obscured.)
4681
4682The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
46ff99c0
MB
4683versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
4684However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
4685ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
1e7db2e9 4686
1e7db2e9
GM
4687** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
4688
6b9572dc
EZ
4689Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
4690systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
4691mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
4692mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
4693displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
4694have enabled one.
1e7db2e9
GM
4695
4696Currently, the following actions have been defined:
4697
3aa2f38a 4698- Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
1e7db2e9 4699
3aa2f38a 4700- Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
1e7db2e9
GM
4701
4702- Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
4703`*') toggles the status.
4704
4705- Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
4706
1e7db2e9
GM
4707** Hourglass pointer
4708
4709Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
4710turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
4711
1e7db2e9
GM
4712** Blinking cursor
4713
4714M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
4715terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
4716and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
4717the group `cursor'.
4718
1e7db2e9
GM
4719** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
4720
4721This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
4722generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
4723See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
4724details.
4725
4726Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
4727have to do anything to activate it.
4728
efeb796b
EZ
4729** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
4730
4731The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
4732determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
4733
4734On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
4735according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
4736key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
4737option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
4738delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
4739keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
4740keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
4741set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
4742
4743If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
4744a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
4745Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
4746`keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
4747the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
4748terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
4749
4750Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
4751to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
4752
1e7db2e9
GM
4753** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
4754changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
4755buffer by default.
4756
4757** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
4758current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
4759beginning and end of the buffer.
4760
4761** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
4762recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
4763signaled.
4764
4765** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
4766file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
4767
1e7db2e9
GM
4768** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
4769compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
4770this behavior.
4771
efeb796b 4772The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
1e7db2e9
GM
4773compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
4774Emacs dump core.
4775
4776** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
4777
4778When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
4779widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
4780Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
4781
4782** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
4783more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
4784now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
4785
4786** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
4787using that menu.
4788
1e7db2e9
GM
4789** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
4790
4791When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
4792whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
4793defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
4794highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
4795displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
4796whitespace.
4797
1e7db2e9
GM
4798** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
4799all frames except the selected one.
4800
4801** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
4802let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
4803
1e7db2e9
GM
4804** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
4805header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
4806so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
4807This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
4808`Info-use-header-line'.
4809
1e7db2e9
GM
4810** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
4811have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
4812`de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
4813
4814** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
4815
4816** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
4817`dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
4818`fr-drdref.tex'.
4819
1e7db2e9
GM
4820** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
4821displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
4822menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
4823menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
4824
efeb796b 4825** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
17851d9d 4826
a19e85cc 4827You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
17851d9d
EZ
4828because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
4829use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
4830`~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
1e7db2e9 4831
1e7db2e9
GM
4832** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
4833point in a pop-up window.
4834
1e7db2e9
GM
4835** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
4836under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
4837customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
4838
4839The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
4840determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
4841
1e7db2e9
GM
4842** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
4843sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
4844(On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
aa082854 4845You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
1e7db2e9 4846
1e7db2e9
GM
4847** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
4848
eb1b0c74
GM
4849** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
4850to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
4851
c607d53d 4852** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
346598f1 4853trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
c607d53d
SS
4854this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
4855
4104194e 4856** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
1e36ff68
DL
4857be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
4858non-nil.
4104194e 4859
ba9eeda1
GM
4860** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
4861set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
4862file that is already visited under a different name.
4863
42ac0ae5
GM
4864** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
4865nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
4866
ba9eeda1 4867** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
eb27839a 4868and displays information about that.
b941a14b 4869
25ad1371
GM
4870** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
4871expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
4872
4873This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
4874determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
4875mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
4876interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
4877regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
4878associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
4879
40e857ea 4880** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
424d8b44 4881suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
40e857ea 4882
c08398de
DL
4883** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
4884buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
4885contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
4886by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
4887insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
4888the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
4889Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
4890
efeb796b
EZ
4891** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
4892been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
4893
efeb796b
EZ
4894** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
4895system for keyboard input.
4896
3d6cd763
GM
4897** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
4898coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
4899escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
4900such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
4901recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
07b14857 4902always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
3d6cd763 4903read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
07b14857
KH
4904(`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
4905RET C-x C-f filename RET.
26ae8525 4906
0b8a3a6d
DL
4907** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
4908environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
4909
0b8a3a6d
DL
4910** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
4911displays all characters in that character set.
4912
4913** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
4914coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
4915
efeb796b
EZ
4916** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
4917and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
4918LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
4919
efeb796b
EZ
4920** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
4921Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
49228859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
4923GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
49248859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
4925There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
4926and Polish `slash'.
4927
efeb796b
EZ
4928** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
4929These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
4930of the tutorial.
4931
4932** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
4933function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
4934Lisp Coding Convention".
4935
4936 new command old-binding
4937 --- ------- -----------
4938 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
4939 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
4940 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
4941
4942 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
4943 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
4944 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
4945
4946 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
4947 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
4948 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
4949 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
4950 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
4951 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
4952
bd161121
EZ
4953** There are new Leim input methods.
4954New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
4955"greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
4956package.
4957
efeb796b
EZ
4958** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
4959rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
4960typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
4961"=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
4962"`", you must type "=q".
4963
efeb796b
EZ
4964** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
49658859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
4966more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
4967empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
4968window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
4969on.
4970
efeb796b
EZ
4971** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
4972on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
4973defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
4974commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
5cb6a58e 4975
5898e075
DL
4976** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
4977`display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
4978indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
4979indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
4980
cc181e95
GM
4981** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
4982on the display using several methods
4983
4984- By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
4985a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
4986be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
4987
4988- By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
5820dead 4989equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
cc181e95 4990
da4496b6 4991- By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
cc181e95
GM
4992
4993- By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
4994the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
4995
3b4fa1b2 4996** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
1c459486 4997an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
3b4fa1b2 4998command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
1c459486 4999does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
0daee095 5000
176256a1 5001** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
3bbc50af
DL
5002`make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
5003typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
176256a1 5004
dd0add8e
DL
5005** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
5006characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
5007
699238d9 5008** New X resources recognized
100b3cbb 5009
7233c5bd
GM
5010*** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
5011whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
5012is useful for debugging X problems.
5013
5014Example:
5015
699238d9 5016 emacs.synchronous: true
7233c5bd 5017
100b3cbb
GM
5018*** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
5019visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
5020the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
5021and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
5022visual class names are
5023
5024 TrueColor
5025 PseudoColor
5026 DirectColor
5027 StaticColor
5028 GrayScale
5029 StaticGray
5030
5031Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
5032`pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
5033meaning.
5034
5035The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
5036supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
5037`visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
5038visual.
5039
5040Example:
5041
699238d9 5042 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
100b3cbb
GM
5043
5044*** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
5045specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
5046default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
5047resource values are `true' or `on'.
5048
5049Example:
5050
699238d9 5051 emacs.privateColormap: true
100b3cbb 5052
a933dad1
DL
5053** Faces and frame parameters.
5054
5055There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
5056Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
5057`scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
5058`scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
5059sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
5060for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
5061parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
5062
5063Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
5064`default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
79214ddf 5065`foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
a933dad1
DL
5066`default' face and vice versa.
5067
f77a4a8a
GM
5068** New face `menu'.
5069
5070The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
f77a4a8a 5071
a933dad1
DL
5072** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
5073
5074The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
5075colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
5076correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
5077the screen gamma of a frame's display.
5078
5079PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
5080in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
5081color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
5082
5083The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
5084`ScreenGamma'.
5085
a933dad1
DL
5086** Tabs and variable-width text.
5087
5088Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
5089defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
5090independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
5091Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
5092
5093** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
5094
5095*** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
5096
5097 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
5098
79dd1637
RS
5099The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
5100LessTif/Motif one.
a933dad1 5101
79dd1637
RS
5102*** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
5103LessTif and Motif.
a933dad1 5104
a933dad1
DL
5105** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
5106
5107As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
5108drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
5109`x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
5110
5111** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
efeb796b 5112bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
a933dad1
DL
5113
5114This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
5115`indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
5116variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
5117
5118** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
5119
5120When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
d9e66103 5121value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
a933dad1 5122number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
d5951185 5123fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
a933dad1
DL
5124
5125When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
8a33023e 5126value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
a933dad1 5127number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
d5951185 5128fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
a933dad1 5129
efeb796b
EZ
5130** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
5131M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
5132M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
5133buffers.
5134
5135** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
5136
5137** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
5138abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
5139`directory-abbrev-alist'.
5140
efeb796b
EZ
5141** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
5142the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
5143forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
5144value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
5145users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
5146even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
5147
5148The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
5149
a933dad1
DL
5150** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
5151notably at the end of lines.
5152
5153All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
5154spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
5155
8748ecc0 5156** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
eee54b0e 5157
8748ecc0
GM
5158** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
5159but inserts text instead of replacing it.
2ce72bfa 5160
a933dad1
DL
5161** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
5162query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
5163after each match to get the replacement text.
5164
d5483ab1
GM
5165** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
5166you edit the replacement string.
4ff40dd0 5167
75823f67
EZ
5168** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
5169(if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
5170in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
4ff40dd0 5171
efeb796b 5172** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
889be0a1 5173
efeb796b
EZ
5174** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
5175to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
327652be 5176
efeb796b
EZ
5177** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
5178the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
5179MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
5180displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
a32da22c 5181
75823f67 5182--
efeb796b
EZ
5183** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
5184read mail from the menu etc.
559cee90 5185
efeb796b
EZ
5186** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
5187This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
5188MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
5189before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
559cee90 5190
efeb796b
EZ
5191** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
5192MS-DOS version of Emacs.
424d8b44 5193
efeb796b
EZ
5194** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
5195of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
5196This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
5197correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
5198but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
5199of Emacs.
eb2aac9d 5200
efeb796b 5201** Customize changes
eb2aac9d 5202
efeb796b
EZ
5203*** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
5204`State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
5205M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
5206customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
5207earlier versions of Emacs.
1b24b888 5208
efeb796b
EZ
5209*** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
5210Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
5211default).
79c78e77 5212
efeb796b
EZ
5213*** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5214does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
5215file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
5216wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
5217file.
79c78e77 5218
7e97c157
EZ
5219** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5220does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
5221avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
5222already in your init file.
5223
efeb796b 5224** New features in evaluation commands
3476b54a 5225
efeb796b
EZ
5226*** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
5227modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
5228print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
5229customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
5230eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
a933dad1 5231
f37e8c77
EZ
5232The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
5233respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
5234the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
5235the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
5236printed).
5237
75c5350a
GM
5238<RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
5239printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
f6e6cdf2 5240
f37e8c77
EZ
5241The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
5242during evaluation produces a backtrace.
5243
3a426197 5244*** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
5e03eb84
GM
5245code when called with a prefix argument.
5246
b1c609b1
GM
5247** CC mode changes.
5248
5249Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
5250current user setups (although it's believed that these
5251incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
5252However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
5253back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
5254compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
5255release.
5256
e120bebf
GM
5257*** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
5258CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
5259is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
5260confusion.
5261
5262However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
5263default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
5264java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
5265notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
5266
5267*** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
5268Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
5269
5270space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
5271parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
5272
5273compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
5274parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
5275It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
5276style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
5277
5278*** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
5279Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
5280"electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
5281earlier statement. An example:
5282
5283for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
5284 if (a[i])
5285 res += a[i]->offset;
5286else
5287
5288Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
5289continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
5290the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
5291possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
5292the preceding "if".
5293
5294CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
5295by default.
5296
5297*** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
5298Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
5299meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
5300documentation or other natural language text.
5301
5302The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
5303contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
5304the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
5305strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
5306to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
5307commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
5308sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
5309
5310*** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
5311Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
5312source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
5313comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
5314
5315*** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
5316When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
5317line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
5318change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
5319Pike mode only.
5320
5321*** Better handling of syntactic errors.
5322The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
5323improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
5324stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
5325following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
5326matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
5327indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
5328is reported afterwards.
5329
5330*** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
5331A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
5332returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
5333
5334*** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
5335Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
5336on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
5337can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
5338code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
5339modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
5340groundwork.
5341
7972fcfc
GM
5342*** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
5343This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
5344of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
5345non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
5346want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
5347have to bother.
5348
5349Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
5350situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
487522fe 5351and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
7972fcfc
GM
5352If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
5353the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
5354by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
5355
b1c609b1
GM
5356*** New initialization procedure for the style system.
5357When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
5358variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
5359take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
5360is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
5361settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
5362possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
5363Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
5364
5365By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
5366special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
5367the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
5368of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
5369above.
5370
5371Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
5372when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
5373function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
5374call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
5375then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
5376values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
5377only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
5378function documentation for more info.
5379
5380The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
5381especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
5382with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
5383intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
5384such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
5385is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
5386configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
5387global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
5388
5389(Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
5390
5391**** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
5392This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
5393
5394This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
5395variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
5396completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
5397the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
5398empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
5399style system.
5400
5401**** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
5402In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
5403c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
5404as far as possible.
5405
5406*** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
5407CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
5408surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
5409chapter about this in the manual.
5410
5411**** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
5412The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
5413recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
5414primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
5415adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
5416
5417**** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
5418This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
5419c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
5420
5421**** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
5422This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
5423
5424It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
5425Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
5426A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
5427inside CC Mode.
5428
5429Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
5430causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
5431the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
5432available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
5433cc-mode/).
5434
9ed462b7
EZ
5435**** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
5436`c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
5437enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
5438function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
5439they were before the filling.
5440
b1c609b1
GM
5441**** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
5442The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
5443specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
5444literals.
5445
5446**** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
5447It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
5448prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
5449you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
5450this function.
5451
5452*** Fixes to IDL mode.
5453It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
5454to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
5455struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
5456Thanks to Eric Eide.
5457
5458*** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
5459It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
5460opening braces hangs and when they don't.
5461
5462**** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
5463
5464*** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
5465See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
5466better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
5467and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
5468
5469*** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
5470previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
5471the column specified by comment-column.
5472
5473*** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
5474In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
5475is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
5476prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
5477contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
5478don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
5479
5480*** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
5481instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
5482arguments.
5483
5484*** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
5485
5486*** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
5487c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
5488c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
5489variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
5490Provan).
5491
5492*** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
5493
efeb796b 5494** Dired changes
c407c570 5495
efeb796b
EZ
5496*** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
5497command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
5498is, delete only empty directories.
c407c570 5499
efeb796b
EZ
5500*** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
5501command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
5502copy directories recursively.
87be76f6 5503
efeb796b
EZ
5504*** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
5505in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
5506the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
3353ef5a 5507
efeb796b
EZ
5508*** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
5509replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
5510directory.
c407c570 5511
a320a8e7 5512*** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
efeb796b
EZ
5513a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
5514This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
5515will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
5516accurate or inaccurate as it is.
5517
5518*** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
5519from ls switches.
5520
5521*** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
5522of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
5523which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
5524source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
a933dad1 5525
efeb796b 5526** Gnus changes.
87be76f6 5527
efeb796b
EZ
5528The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
5529four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
5530internationalization and mail-fetching.
87be76f6 5531
efeb796b
EZ
5532*** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
5533many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
87be76f6 5534
efeb796b 5535If you used procmail like in
87be76f6 5536
efeb796b
EZ
5537(setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
5538(setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
5539(setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
5540(setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
35384f06 5541
efeb796b 5542this now has changed to
87be76f6 5543
efeb796b
EZ
5544(setq mail-sources
5545 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
5546 :suffix ".in")))
d7b511c4 5547
efeb796b
EZ
5548More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
5549Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
d67f47e4 5550
efeb796b
EZ
5551*** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
5552Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
5553Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
5554longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
d7b511c4 5555
efeb796b
EZ
5556The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
5557use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
5558installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
9d453139 5559
efeb796b
EZ
5560*** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
5561parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
5562are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
5563now just a compatibility layer.
4b9347b3 5564
75823f67
EZ
5565*** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
5566Gnus facilities.
5567
efeb796b
EZ
5568*** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
5569called to position point.
4b9347b3 5570
efeb796b
EZ
5571*** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
5572summary buffers and NOV files.
79214ddf 5573
efeb796b
EZ
5574*** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
5575of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
79214ddf 5576
efeb796b
EZ
5577*** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
5578subtly different manner.
aca0be23 5579
efeb796b
EZ
5580*** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
5581and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
5582ever-changing layouts.
79214ddf 5583
efeb796b 5584*** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
79214ddf 5585
efeb796b 5586*** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
8c463abe 5587
efeb796b 5588** Changes in Texinfo mode.
8c463abe 5589
efeb796b
EZ
5590*** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
5591macros
79214ddf 5592
efeb796b
EZ
5593 Key binding Macro
5594 -------------------------
5595 C-c C-c C-s @strong
5596 C-c C-c C-e @emph
5597 C-c C-c u @uref
5598 C-c C-c q @quotation
5599 C-c C-c m @email
5600 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
5601 M-RET @item
79214ddf 5602
efeb796b 5603*** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
79214ddf 5604
efeb796b 5605** Changes in Outline mode.
79214ddf 5606
efeb796b
EZ
5607There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
5608`outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
5609the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
89d57763 5610
efeb796b 5611** Changes to Emacs Server
79214ddf 5612
efeb796b
EZ
5613*** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
5614with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
5615are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
5616Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
5617buffers to kill, as before.
79214ddf 5618
efeb796b
EZ
5619Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
5620i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
5621this way.
5622
5623** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
5624of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
5625
5626** Changes to Show Paren mode.
5627
5628*** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
5629The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
5630use. Default is 1000.
79214ddf 5631
efeb796b
EZ
5632** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
5633groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
f6737cde 5634
efeb796b 5635** Changes to hideshow.el
3f6e4b8b 5636
efeb796b 5637*** Generalized block selection and traversal
f6737cde 5638
efeb796b
EZ
5639A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
5640and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
5641serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
5642See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
f6737cde 5643
efeb796b
EZ
5644*** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
5645hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
5646be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
5647the open block.
f6737cde 5648
efeb796b
EZ
5649*** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
5650function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
5651the normal block-hiding function.
f6737cde 5652
efeb796b 5653*** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
f6737cde 5654
efeb796b
EZ
5655*** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
5656roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
5657for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
5658for `hs-minor-mode'.
f6737cde 5659
efeb796b
EZ
5660*** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
5661hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
f6737cde 5662
efeb796b 5663** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
f6737cde 5664
efeb796b
EZ
5665*** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
5666an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
5667log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
0c68ce6f 5668
efeb796b
EZ
5669**** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
5670current buffer.
d521e087 5671
efeb796b
EZ
5672*** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
5673in a log file.
1e7db2e9 5674
efeb796b
EZ
5675*** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
5676entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
5677Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
5678version number is performed based on regular expressions from
5679`change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
5680Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
5681
5682*** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
5683
5684** Changes to cmuscheme
5685
5686*** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
5687`cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
5688
5689** Changes in Font Lock
5690
5691*** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
5692font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
5693
5694*** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
5695set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
5696
5697*** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
5698the face used for each string/comment.
5699
5700*** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
5701Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
5702
5703** Changes to Shell mode
5704
5705*** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
5706to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
5707non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
5708prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
5709
5710** Comint (subshell) changes
5711
5712These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
5713include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
5714
5715*** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
5716Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
5717BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
5718beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
5719respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
5720the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
5721
5722*** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
5723to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
5724parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
5725user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
5726this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
5727respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
5728feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
5729`comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
5730
5731*** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
5732and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
5733
5734*** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
5735buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
5736buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
5737
5738The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
5739M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
5740the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
5741
5742*** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
5743and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
5744see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
5745
5746*** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
5747saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
5748argument, it appends to the file.
5749
5750*** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
5751(usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
5752compatibility.
5753
5754*** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
5755ring (history).
5756
5757*** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
5758identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
5759strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
5760
5761** Changes to Rmail mode
5762
5763*** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
5764set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
5765receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
5766recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
5767`user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
5768as correspondent.
5769
5770Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
5771mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
5772regexp matching your mail addresses.
5773
5774*** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
5775to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
5776Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
5777with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
5778for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
5779
5780*** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
5781like `j'.
5782
5783*** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
5784specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
5785digest message.
5786
5787*** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
5788in which folder to put messages automatically.
5789
5790*** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
5791with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
5792due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
5793
5794** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
5795an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
5796
75823f67
EZ
5797** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
5798use the -f option when sending mail.
5799
f68113db
EZ
5800** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
5801current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
5802the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
5803This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
5804by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
5805displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
5806
5807If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
5808other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
5809`rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
5810
efeb796b
EZ
5811** Changes to TeX mode
5812
5813*** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
5814`latex-mode'.
5815
5816*** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
5817
5818*** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
5819
5820*** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
5821
5822** Changes to RefTeX mode
5823
5824*** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
5825 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
5826 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
5827 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
5828 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
5829 can be edited from that buffer.
5830
5831*** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
5832 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
5833 `A' to use all marked entries).
5834
5835*** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
5836 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
5837
5838*** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
5839 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
5840 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
5841 been cited.
5842
5843** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
5844The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
5845semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
5846in column 1 are always made leaves.
5847
5848** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
5849has the following new features:
5850
5851*** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
5852may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
5853to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
5854time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
5855
5856*** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
5857feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
5858file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
5859compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
5860pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
5861defaults to 1.
5862
5863** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
5864file names.
5865
5866** Ispell changes
fbc164de 5867
efeb796b
EZ
5868*** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
5869transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
5870spell-checks the current buffer.
59c1bf85 5871
efeb796b
EZ
5872*** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
5873added.
732b9cdd 5874
efeb796b
EZ
5875*** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
5876correction is made and re-checked.
b8b2ea31 5877
4cdf4bde 5878*** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
b8b2ea31 5879
efeb796b
EZ
5880*** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
5881cases.
b8b2ea31 5882
efeb796b
EZ
5883*** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
5884on syntax errors.
5885
5886*** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
5887end of the buffer.
5888
5889*** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
5890
efeb796b
EZ
5891** Makefile mode changes
5892
5893*** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
b8b2ea31 5894
efeb796b
EZ
5895*** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
5896Fontlock mode is active.
1e406be0 5897
efeb796b 5898** Isearch changes
e33b0397 5899
efeb796b
EZ
5900*** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
5901so that searches can be resumed.
e33b0397 5902
3a426197 5903*** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
efeb796b
EZ
5904respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
5905that started the search.
5906
5907*** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
5908selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
6f8ea2ae 5909
efeb796b 5910*** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
c0510d27 5911
efeb796b
EZ
5912Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
5913`isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
5914search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
5915before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
5916highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
5917`secondary-selection'.
5d94f558 5918
efeb796b
EZ
5919The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
5920will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
5921Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
5922using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
5923usual snappy response.
dc28878c 5924
efeb796b
EZ
5925If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
5926matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
5927set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
5928isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
95931eb1 5929
54baed30
GM
5930** VC Changes
5931
5932VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
5933easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
5934Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
5935to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
5936changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
60a441a5 5937`vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
54baed30
GM
5938version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
5939each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
5940file is registered in that backend.
5941
5942When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
5943backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
5944directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
5945master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
5946the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
5947As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
5948
5949The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
5950still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
5951RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
5952vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
5953where it doesn't make sense.)
5954
5955The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
5956obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
5957`CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
5958
5959*** General Changes
5960
5961The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
5962checks are always done now.
5963
327652be 5964VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
54baed30
GM
5965operations.
5966
c286608e
SM
5967`vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
5968`vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
5969`vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
5970
22933be8
AS
5971The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
5972first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
5973current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
5974the working file (``merge news'').
5975
5976The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
5977(vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
5978downwards.
5979
5980*** Multiple Backends
5981
5982VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
5983useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
5984repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
5985commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
5986local RCS archives.
5987
5988To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
5989should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
5990backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
5991`vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
5992
60a441a5
AS
5993You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
5994C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
5995a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
5996if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
5997current revision number from the more remote backend.
22933be8
AS
5998
5999If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
6000another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
6001any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
6002pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
6003
6004After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
6005changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
6006local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
6007buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
6008
54baed30
GM
6009*** Changes for CVS
6010
6011There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
6012default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
6013remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
6014by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
6015regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
6016that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
6017queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
6018
22933be8
AS
6019If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
6020repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
6021revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
6022any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
6023backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
6024number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
6025(vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
6026of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
6027the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
105602b1
EZ
6028automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
6029since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
6030name.)
22933be8 6031
54baed30
GM
6032If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
6033repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
6034If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
22933be8 6035commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
54baed30
GM
6036current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
6037entire directory tree.
6038
6039The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
6040"cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
6041is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
6042"watched" by other developers.)
6043
22933be8
AS
6044The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6045(vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
60a441a5 6046an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
22933be8
AS
6047starting at the given directory.
6048
54baed30
GM
6049*** Lisp Changes in VC
6050
6051VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
6052add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
6053library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
6054then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
60a441a5
AS
6055a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
6056provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
54baed30 6057of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
60a441a5
AS
6058you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
6059`SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
54baed30 6060
c4ed232b 6061** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
732b9cdd
GM
6062SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
6063terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
6064See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
6065
a933dad1
DL
6066** New modes and packages
6067
79b9f6e0
MB
6068*** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
6069automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
6070the default is not applicable.
6071
b95b34e5
GM
6072*** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
6073rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
6074shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
6075
6076Features are:
6077
6078- Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
6079 drawn, like this: | \ /
c607d53d 6080 --+-- X
b95b34e5
GM
6081 | / \
6082
6083- Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
6084 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
6085 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
6086 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
6087 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
6088 you are drawing.
6089
6090- Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
6091 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
6092
6093- Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
6094 flood-filling.
6095
6096- Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
6097 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
6098 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
6099 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
c607d53d 6100
b95b34e5
GM
6101- Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
6102 also do without the mouse.
6103
6104- Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
6105 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
6106 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
6107 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
6108 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
6109
6110- Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
6111
6112 lines straight-lines
6113 rectangles squares
6114 poly-lines straight poly-lines
6115 ellipses circles
6116 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
6117 spray-can setting size for spraying
6118 vaporize line vaporize lines
6119 erase characters erase rectangles
6120
6121 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
6122 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
6123 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
6124 drawing.
6125
6126 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
6127 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
6128 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
6129 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
6130
6131- Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
6132 can be turned off).
6133
4473cdd9
JW
6134*** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
6135implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
6136It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
6137functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
6138history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
6139will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
6140the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
6141rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
6142all within the scope of your Emacs process.
6143
90cbf47e
GM
6144*** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
6145intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
6146typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
6147on certain projects.
6148
baf7eee4
GM
6149*** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
6150of interactively entered regexps. For example,
abb2db1c 6151
d96d6bb0 6152 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
abb2db1c
GM
6153
6154will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
6155face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
6156typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
6157Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
6158appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
6159current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
baf7eee4
GM
6160corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
6161to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
abb2db1c 6162
d96d6bb0 6163*** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
abb2db1c
GM
6164Emacs is idle.
6165
b4c3513f
EZ
6166*** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
6167fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
6168
31fc5d15
GM
6169*** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
6170parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
6171
5cb6a58e
SM
6172*** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
6173package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
6174be more robust while offering the same functionality.
601e0081
SM
6175`comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
6176comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
5cb6a58e 6177
578979ee
GM
6178*** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
6179facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
6180separate Texinfo file.
6181
424d8b44
DL
6182*** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
6183by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
6184provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
6185`log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
8a33023e 6186enter check-in log messages.
dc1178bf 6187
6abca616
EZ
6188*** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
6189without invoking external programs.
6190
6191The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
6192and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
6193`manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
6194is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
490f2e7b 6195Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
6abca616
EZ
6196
6197The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
6198page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
6199
5e5dff44
GM
6200*** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
6201authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
6202
6203The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
6204the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
6205the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
6206Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
6207even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
6208single step.
6209
6210On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
6211matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
6212probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
6213contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
6214
f7136ee8
GM
6215*** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
6216unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
6217actually modifying content of a buffer.
6218
bbd9b566
GM
6219*** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
6220PostScript.
6221
6222Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
6223
6224The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
6225
6226 ; comment (until end of line)
6227 A non-terminal
6228 "C" terminal
6229 ?C? special
6230 $A default non-terminal
6231 $"C" default terminal
6232 $?C? default special
6233 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
6234 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
6235 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
6236 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
6237 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
6238 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
6239 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
6240 C+ one or more occurrences of C
6241 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
6242 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
6243 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
6244 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
6245 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
6246 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6247 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6248
6249Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
6250
99453a38
GM
6251*** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
6252align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
6253determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
6254example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
6255equal signs of assignments.
6256
559cee90
DL
6257*** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
6258paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
6259
6448a6b3
GM
6260*** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
6261list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
2018166d 6262buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
6448a6b3 6263
6344985d
GM
6264*** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
6265
249652b1
GM
6266*** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
6267replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
6268is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
6269and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
6270not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
6271which answers different needs.
6272
3476b54a
GM
6273*** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
6274suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
6275expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
6276course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
6277reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
6278to be enabled.
6279
8964fec7
SM
6280*** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
6281containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
6282
a933dad1
DL
6283*** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
6284
16837afc
GM
6285*** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
6286current line in the current buffer. It also provides
dfd67a62 6287`global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
a933dad1
DL
6288
6289*** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
6290
fba448c1 6291Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
8901d1ac
GM
6292`global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
6293disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
6294`comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
6295displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
6296and background colors.
6297
a933dad1
DL
6298*** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
6299Pascal) language.
6300
6301*** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
6302the text at point.
6303
6304*** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
6305
8d54eb69
DL
6306*** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
6307
732b9cdd
GM
6308*** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
6309whitespace in a file.
a933dad1 6310
ebcfda83
GM
6311*** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
6312files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
6313(very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
6314interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
6315often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
6316uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
6317codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
6318
6319*** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
6320
6321Here is an example of columns:
6322
6323horse apple bus
6324dog pineapple car EXTRA
6325porcupine strawberry airplane
6326
6327Doing the following settings:
6328
6329 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
6330 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
6331 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
6332 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
6333
6334
6335Selecting the lines above and typing:
6336
6337 M-x delimit-columns-region
6338
6339It results:
6340
6341[ horse , apple , bus , ]
6342[ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
6343[ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
6344
6345delim-col has the following options:
6346
6347 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
6348 before all columns.
6349
6350 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
6351 between each column.
6352
6353 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
6354 after all columns.
6355
6356 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
6357 each column.
6358
6359delim-col has the following commands:
6360
6361 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
6362 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
6363
2018166d
DL
6364*** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
6365operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
6366menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
6367recent file list can be displayed:
f507826c 6368
31fc5d15 6369- organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
8a33023e
GM
6370- sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
6371- showing paths relative to the current default-directory
f507826c 6372
31fc5d15
GM
6373The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
6374dynamically change the menu appearance.
f507826c 6375
8062f458
DL
6376*** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
6377text.
6378
36e24b82 6379*** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
91735437
DL
6380of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
6381specific to Message mode.
6382
36e24b82
DL
6383*** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
6384viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
6385with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
6386
aaa659ef
DL
6387*** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
6388interface to access directory servers using different directory
6389protocols. It has a separate manual.
6390
eee54b0e
DL
6391*** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
6392for Autoconf, selected automatically.
6393
612839b6
GM
6394*** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
6395
5d94f558 6396*** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
612839b6 6397minibuffer with completion.
aaa659ef 6398
399da7e3
DL
6399*** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
6400with the diary features.
6401
6e417ca5
DL
6402*** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
6403numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
6404
4a27bdfb
GM
6405*** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
6406Fill mode.
6407
dace60cf
JW
6408*** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
6409facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
6410difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
6411they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
a18a342d 6412
9540ec3f
EZ
6413*** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
6414It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
6415`.g'.
6416
efeb796b
EZ
6417** Changes in sort.el
6418
6419The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
6420as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
6421new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
6422numeric base.
6423
6424** Changes to Ange-ftp
6425
efeb796b
EZ
6426*** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
6427names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
6428sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
6429
6430*** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
6431ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
6432
6433*** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
6434output ^M at the end of lines.
6435
efeb796b
EZ
6436** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
6437mode `iswitchb-mode'.
6438
efeb796b
EZ
6439** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
6440If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
6441`(msb-mode 1)'.
6442
6443** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
6444group.
6445
6446** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
6447behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
6448are recognized:
6449
6450`untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
6451`hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
6452`all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
6453nil -- just delete one character.
6454
6455Default value is `untabify'.
6456
6457[This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
6458
6459** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
6460symbol, not double-quoted.
6461
6462** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
6463version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
6464profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
6465moved to lisp/obsolete.
6466
6467** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
6468To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
6469`auto-compression-mode' command.
6470
6471** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
6472`browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
6473`browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
6474
6475** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
6476`browse-url-new-window-flag'.
6477
efeb796b
EZ
6478** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
6479operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
6480
efeb796b
EZ
6481** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
6482is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
6483
6484** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
6485support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
6486use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
6487buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
6488M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
6489new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
6490
efeb796b
EZ
6491** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
6492a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
6493
6494** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
6495
6496The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
6497file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
6498
6499** Shell script mode changes.
6500
6501Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
6502derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
6503sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
6504
6505** Etags changes.
6506
6507*** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
6508
6509*** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
6510possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
6511{lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
6512This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
6513a regular expression. The manual contains details.
6514
6515*** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
6516declarations when given the --declarations option.
6517
6518*** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
6519"operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
6520
6521*** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
6522automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
6523`template' keywords.
6524
6525*** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
6526C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
6527
6528*** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
6529types.
6530
6531*** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
6532
6533*** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
6534
6535*** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
6536are now tagged.
6537
6538*** In makefiles, tags the targets.
6539
6540*** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
6541variables are tagged.
6542
6543*** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
6544
6545*** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
6546for PSWrap.
6547
efeb796b
EZ
6548** Changes in etags.el
6549
6550*** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
6551tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
6552is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
6553
6554*** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
6555the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
6556
6557If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
6558FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
6559TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
6560obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
6561
6562TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
6563
6564FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
6565List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
6566
6567A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
6568
6569 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
6570 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
6571 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
6572
6573*** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
6574of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
6575
6576*** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
6577names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
6578
6579*** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
6580If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
6581/tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
6582"dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
6583point will go to the beginning of the file.
6584
6585*** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
6586auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
6587(with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
6588
6589*** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
6590in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
6591found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
6592
efeb796b
EZ
6593** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
6594remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
6595appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
6596
6597** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
6598
efeb796b
EZ
6599** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
6600
efeb796b
EZ
6601** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
6602containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
6603expression from that list, are not checked.
6604
6605** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
6606When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
6607and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
6608the buffer, just like for the local files.
6609
6610** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
6611
efeb796b
EZ
6612** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
6613displays local abbrevs, only.
6614
965bc065
DL
6615** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
6616paragraphs filled as you modify them.
6617
4e8864c7
GM
6618** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
6619may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
6620is measured in pixels.
6621
965bc065
DL
6622** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
6623to be visited as images.
6624
68d0efa6
GM
6625** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
6626were added to compile.el.
6627
a933dad1
DL
6628** Withdrawn packages
6629
6630*** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
6631functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
25a81338 6632
3261c1d8
DL
6633*** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
6634
6635*** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
ce75fd23 6636
05197f40 6637\f
01242779
DL
6638* Incompatible Lisp changes
6639
6640There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
6641may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
3b6936cc 6642See the sections below for details.
01242779 6643
89d57763 6644** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
9b2a085d 6645`(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
bd1190d7
RS
6646Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
6647to remove the properties of the copy.
01242779
DL
6648
6649** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
6650which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
6651may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
6652these properties are active.
6653
4dd4cc14 6654** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
01242779 6655ranges may affect some code.
1c14ba45
DL
6656
6657** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
6658buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
6659make a difference to some code.
6660
4dd4cc14
DL
6661** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
6662operates on the minibuffer.
6663
7c94ccf6
EZ
6664** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
6665cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
6666different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
6667(previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
6668Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
6669character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
6670multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
6671encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
6672reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
6673sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
6674a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
6675the buffer as multibyte characters.
6676
6677Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
6678MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
6679appropriate for reading truly binary files.
6680
7a39158f 6681** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
3280fbe8
EZ
6682`after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
6683`before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
7a39158f
DL
6684
6685** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
539e74f9
EZ
6686long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
6687such as `mapconcat'.
7a39158f 6688
55bb62fd
EZ
6689** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
6690string.
6691
f34eb373
DL
6692** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
6693extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
6694dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
6695one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
6696charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
6697the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
028d739a
DL
6698encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
6699probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
3478eafc 6700
98384b7b
EZ
6701** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
6702Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
6703aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
6704not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
6705on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
6706behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
6707turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
6708remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
6709advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
6710will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
7cd5f1e7 6711
05197f40 6712\f
ce75fd23
GM
6713* Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
6714(Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
6715
e3b22517
GM
6716** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
6717
1ff74324 6718** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
9e5a7f2a
GM
6719allows the animated display of strings.
6720
ed31fabf
GM
6721** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
6722interactive form of a function.
6723
2018166d
DL
6724** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
6725between custom options. Example:
6726
6727 (defcustom default-input-method nil
6728 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
6729 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
6730 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
6731 :group 'mule
6732 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
6733 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
6734
6735This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
6736current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
6737first in a custom-set-variables statement.
6738
f3780fe4 6739** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
a758f97d
GM
6740function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
6741args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
6742(signal or normal termination).
6743
023045d6
DL
6744** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
6745from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
6746
eb1b0c74
GM
6747** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
6748to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
6749
52d89894
GM
6750** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
6751alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
6752
693c4692 6753** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
4301cf66 6754
6bc92b2e
GM
6755** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
6756deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
6757being deleted.
6758
39e776cd
SM
6759** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
6760
1396138a 6761** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
a18a342d
DL
6762If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
6763skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
6764with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
6765C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
6766charset.
6767
4fbdfdcf
MB
6768** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
6769the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
6770message.
6771
6a0b0752
MB
6772** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
6773expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
6774
47e351a3
GM
6775** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
6776with the more general `:mask' property.
6777
f864120f 6778** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
ba9eeda1 6779
a2bd77b8
GM
6780** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
6781backslash.
6782
424d8b44
DL
6783** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
6784is running in batch mode. For example,
6785
6786 (message "%s" (read t))
6787
6788will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
6789to standard output.
6790
424d8b44
DL
6791** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
6792`kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
6793
ead53494
GM
6794** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
6795will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
6796frame or window.
6797
27848c01
GM
6798** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
6799were added
6800
6801- Function: remove ELT SEQ
6802
8a33023e 6803Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
27848c01
GM
6804a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
6805
6806- Function: remq ELT LIST
6807
8a33023e 6808Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
27848c01
GM
6809comparison is done with `eq'.
6810
6811** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
3ab82477 6812
b548072f 6813** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
c8682017 6814has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
92d2f186 6815`key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
b548072f 6816
07b14857
KH
6817** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
6818without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
6819convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
6820
9662da0b
GM
6821** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
6822or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
d5aa31d8 6823
7fce7efb
DL
6824** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
6825function was declared obsolete.
6826
5d94f558 6827** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
7fce7efb
DL
6828retained as an alias).
6829
593b3517
RS
6830** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
6831the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
f98d3086 6832
87efd256
GM
6833** The new function `window-list' has been defined
6834
39b39373
GM
6835- Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
6836
6837Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
6838omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
6839the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
6840even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
6841minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
6842means never include the minibuffer window.
87efd256 6843
a56ebb90 6844** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
67c9a1d2 6845
a56ebb90 6846- Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
67c9a1d2
GM
6847
6848Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
6849
6850This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
6851calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
6852argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
6853value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
6854returned.
6855
6856Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
6857if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
6858it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
6859minibuffer even if it is active.
6860
6861Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
6862counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
6863too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
6864and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
6865`walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
6866entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
6867
6868ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
6869ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
6870ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
6871ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
6872ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
6873If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
6874Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
6875
ead53494
GM
6876** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
6877event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
6878argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
dce6b995 6879
25fa6deb
GM
6880** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
6881call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
088831a6
GM
6882message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
6883Default value is nil.
25fa6deb 6884
5d94f558 6885** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
1681ead6
GM
6886meaning no limit.
6887
5b034b7f
EZ
6888** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
6889the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
6890numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
6891
5d94f558 6892** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
c08398de
DL
6893coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
6894DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
6895
9b2999d0
DL
6896** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
6897list of a primitive.
de370c4c 6898
c286608e
SM
6899** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
6900
80c05bd3
DL
6901** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
6902buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
6903This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
6904than replacing the local map.
6905
14fd0da3
DL
6906** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
6907`after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
6908removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
6909instead.
45f485a6
GM
6910
6911** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
6912
c286608e
SM
6913** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
6914as promised long ago.
f0298744 6915
5d94f558 6916** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
ac57988b
GM
6917
6918** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
6919for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
6920patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
6921
05197f40 6922\f
a933dad1
DL
6923* Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
6924
6260538e
GM
6925** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
6926regular expressions.
6927
6928- Function: rx-to-string SEXP
6929
6930Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
6931
6932- Macro: rx SEXP
6933
6934Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
6935
6936The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
6937notation.
6938
6939STRING
6940 matches string STRING literally.
6941
6942CHAR
6943 matches character CHAR literally.
6944
6945`not-newline'
6946 matches any character except a newline.
6947 .
6948`anything'
6949 matches any character
6950
6951`(any SET)'
6952 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
6953 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
6954
79014980 6955'(in SET)'
6260538e
GM
6956 like `any'.
6957
6958`(not (any SET))'
6959 matches any character not in SET
6960
6961`line-start'
6962 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
6963 in the text being matched
6964
6965`line-end'
6966 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
6967
6968`string-start'
6969 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
6970 string being matched against.
6971
6972`string-end'
6973 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
6974 string being matched against.
6975
6976`buffer-start'
6977 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
6978 buffer being matched against.
6979
6980`buffer-end'
6981 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
6982 buffer being matched against.
6983
6984`point'
6985 matches the empty string, but only at point.
6986
6987`word-start'
6988 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
6989 word.
6990
6991`word-end'
6992 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
6993
6994`word-boundary'
6995 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
6996 word.
6997
6998`(not word-boundary)'
6999 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
7000 word.
7001
7002`digit'
7003 matches 0 through 9.
7004
7005`control'
7006 matches ASCII control characters.
7007
7008`hex-digit'
7009 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
7010
7011`blank'
7012 matches space and tab only.
7013
7014`graphic'
7015 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
7016 space, and DEL.
7017
7018`printing'
7019 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
7020 and DEL.
7021
7022`alphanumeric'
7023 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7024 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7025
7026`letter'
7027 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7028 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7029
7030`ascii'
7031 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
7032
7033`nonascii'
7034 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
7035
7036`lower'
7037 matches anything lower-case.
7038
7039`upper'
7040 matches anything upper-case.
7041
7042`punctuation'
7043 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7044 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
7045
7046`space'
7047 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
7048
7049`word'
7050 matches anything that has word syntax.
7051
7052`(syntax SYNTAX)'
7053 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
7054 of the following symbols.
7055
7056 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
7057 `punctuation' (\\s.)
7058 `word' (\\sw)
7059 `symbol' (\\s_)
7060 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
7061 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
7062 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
7063 `string-quote' (\\s\")
7064 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
7065 `escape' (\\s\\)
7066 `character-quote' (\\s/)
7067 `comment-start' (\\s<)
7068 `comment-end' (\\s>)
7069
7070`(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
7071 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
7072
7073`(category CATEGORY)'
7074 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
7075 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
7076
7077 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
7078 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
7079 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
7080 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
7081 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
7082 `symbol' (\\c5)
7083 `digit' (\\c6)
7084 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
7085 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
7086 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
7087 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
7088 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
7089 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
7090 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
7091 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
7092 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
175573ac 7093 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
6260538e
GM
7094 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
7095 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
7096 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
7097 `ascii' (\\ca)
7098 `arabic' (\\cb)
7099 `chinese' (\\cc)
7100 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
7101 `greek' (\\cg)
7102 `korean' (\\ch)
7103 `indian' (\\ci)
7104 `japanese' (\\cj)
7105 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
7106 `latin' (\\cl)
7107 `lao' (\\co)
7108 `tibetan' (\\cq)
7109 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
7110 `thai' (\\ct)
7111 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
7112 `hebrew' (\\cw)
7113 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
7114 `can-break' (\\c|)
7115
7116`(not (category CATEGORY))'
7117 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
7118
7119`(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7120 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
7121
7122`(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7123 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
7124 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
7125
7126`(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7127 another name for `submatch'.
7128
7129`(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7130 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
7131 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
7132 regular expression.
7133
7134`(minimal-match SEXP)'
7135 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
e0e7f2d5 7136 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
6260538e
GM
7137 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
7138 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
7139
7140`(maximal-match SEXP)'
c3518b63 7141 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
6260538e
GM
7142
7143`(zero-or-more SEXP)'
7144 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7145
7146`(0+ SEXP)'
7147 like `zero-or-more'.
7148
7149`(* SEXP)'
7150 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7151
7152`(*? SEXP)'
7153 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7154
7155`(one-or-more SEXP)'
7156 matches one or more occurrences of A.
79014980 7157
6260538e
GM
7158`(1+ SEXP)'
7159 like `one-or-more'.
7160
7161`(+ SEXP)'
7162 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7163
7164`(+? SEXP)'
7165 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7166
7167`(zero-or-one SEXP)'
7168 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
79014980 7169
6260538e
GM
7170`(optional SEXP)'
7171 like `zero-or-one'.
7172
7173`(? SEXP)'
7174 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7175
7176`(?? SEXP)'
7177 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7178
7179`(repeat N SEXP)'
7180 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7181
7182`(repeat N M SEXP)'
7183 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7184
7185`(eval FORM)'
c3518b63 7186 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
6260538e
GM
7187 `regexp-quote' it.
7188
7189`(regexp REGEXP)'
7190 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
7191
697617d9
GM
7192*** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
7193
85c75536
MB
7194*** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
7195buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
7196the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
7197restriction to be restored incorrectly.
7198
0b8a3a6d
DL
7199*** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
7200`eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
028d739a 7201when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
0b8a3a6d
DL
7202multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
7203
fb2c6a6b 7204*** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
58008c36
EZ
7205`string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
7206if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
0b8a3a6d
DL
7207
7208*** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
7209changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
7210[\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
7211regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
7212the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
7213extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
7214bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
7215eight-bit-graphic.
7216
7217** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
7218
9b2a085d 7219A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
0b8a3a6d
DL
7220a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
7221character set as previously.
7222
7223*** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
7224They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
7225modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
7226
7227CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
7228characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
7229range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
7230case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
7231
7232FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
9b2a085d 7233name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
0b8a3a6d
DL
7234
7235*** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
7236registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
7237"fontset-default".
7238
7239*** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
7240argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
7241
7242** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
7243composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
7244buffers and strings.
7245
7246*** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
7247character' which is an independent character with a unique character
7248code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
7249have been deleted: composite-char-component,
7250composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
7251composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
7252The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
7253also been deleted.
7254
7255*** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
7256specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
7257`reference-point-alist' for more detail.
7258
7259*** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
7260MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
7261composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
7262may differ between buffer and string text.
7263
7264*** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
7265COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
7266
7267*** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
7268directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
7269Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
7270`composition' from STRING.
7271
7272*** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
7273a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
7274
7275*** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
7276obsolete.
7277
889be0a1
DL
7278** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
7279the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
7280
965bc065 7281** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
1e36ff68
DL
7282`mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
7283introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
7284U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
0b8a3a6d 7285
3d7a4ec8
EZ
7286Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
7287characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
7288etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
7289different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
7290which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
7291encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
7292
7293** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
7294It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
7295details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
23cfab61 7296
0b8a3a6d 7297** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
1e36ff68
DL
7298`japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
7299standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
7300
7301** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
7302have been introduced.
0b8a3a6d 7303
0b8a3a6d 7304** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
1e36ff68 7305have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
028d739a
DL
73060xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
7307eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
7308emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
2018166d
DL
7309buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
7310eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
7311must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
7312their multibyte equivalent.
0b8a3a6d 7313
f0124b4a
DL
7314** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
7315that offset in the file before writing.
7316
f98d3086
SM
7317** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
7318compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
7464346d 7319
612839b6
GM
7320** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
7321`*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
7322from which the command was issued.
7323
7324** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
7325`query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
7326`replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
7327additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
7328operate on.
7329
271b4185
GM
7330** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
7331to `window-buffer-height'.
7332
7333- Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
7334
7335Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
7336The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
7337lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
7338
7339Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
7340respectively.
7341
8a33023e 7342If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
271b4185
GM
7343COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
7344
7345The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
7346obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
7347on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
7348
7349Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
7350buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
7351possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
7352is currently displayed in some window.
7353
3c30cb6e
DL
7354** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
7355argument function's results.
7356
62f20204 7357** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
55bb62fd 7358signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
c8682017
EZ
7359`base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
736020, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
55bb62fd 7361sequence).
62f20204 7362
c0510d27 7363** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
b4da8dfa 7364header in the list of headers passed to it.
c0510d27
GM
7365
7366** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
7367ignores differences in case and text representation.
7368
7369** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
19d1bc27
GM
7370cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
7371as follows:
7372
7373 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
7374 nil don't display a cursor
7375 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
7376 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
7377 others display a box cursor.
7378
9a0dd3dc
GM
7379** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
7380an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
7381defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
7382set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
7383
d7b511c4 7384** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
dc1178bf 7385specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
d7b511c4
GM
7386the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
7387text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
7388
7389Example:
7390
7391 (string-to-syntax "()")
7392 => (4 . 41)
7393
1fa28578
GM
7394** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
7395other than 10.
7396
7397*** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
7398INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
7399
5d94f558 7400 #b1111
1fa28578 7401 => 15
5d94f558 7402 #b-1111
1fa28578
GM
7403 => -15
7404
7405*** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
7406
5d94f558 7407 #o666
1fa28578
GM
7408 => 438
7409
7410*** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
7411
5d94f558 7412 #xbeef
1fa28578
GM
7413 => 48815
7414
7415*** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
7416
5d94f558 7417 #2R-111
1fa28578 7418 => -7
5d94f558 7419 #25rah
1fa28578
GM
7420 => 267
7421
3d4ff2dd 7422** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
f98d3086 7423the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
e9b4e5ff
GM
7424and isn't a string.
7425
3d4ff2dd
GM
7426** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
7427a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
7428value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
7429not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
7430
16ce590d
DL
7431** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
7432
73825616 7433** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
16ce590d
DL
7434for a regexp in a string.
7435
7436** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
7437`mouse-position-function'.
7438
723e779c
GM
7439** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
7440that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
7441
d1e103b2
GM
7442** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
7443Keywords are now always considered constants.
7444
31047e0d
DL
7445** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
7446returns it.
7447
7a85e4df
GM
7448** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
7449returned by function `recent-keys'.
7450
02b14400
RS
7451** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
7452can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
3a426197 7453Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
02b14400
RS
7454etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
7455mode.
404fa7d6 7456
8964fec7
SM
7457** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
7458and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
7459
02b14400
RS
7460** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
7461has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
7462function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
7463returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
7464been performed."
7465
7466When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
7467and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
7468hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
7469then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
ef961722 7470
81da8b32
GM
7471** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
7472In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
7473and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
7474
9e207b90
GM
7475** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
7476with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
7477specified table.
7478
7479 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
7480
7481Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
03d9c64c
GM
7482TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
7483saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
7484what BODY returns.
9e207b90 7485
d7f89643 7486** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
95cd4c40 7487Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
8a33023e 7488Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
601e0081
SM
7489corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
7490Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
8964fec7 7491
dde9e75a
GM
7492** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
7493removed since it wasn't used by anything.
7494
9da30515
GM
7495** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
7496instead of being optional.
7497
d20679eb
GM
7498** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
7499modify read-only text.
7500
fbc164de
PE
7501** New functions and variables for locales.
7502
7503The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
7504decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
b718982a
PE
7505time functions like strftime. The new variables
7506`system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
7507locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
fbc164de
PE
7508
7509The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
7510environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
7511the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
b718982a
PE
7512environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
7513not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
7514`locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
7515`locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
fbc164de 7516
863476d1
SM
7517** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
7518To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
7519modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
7520start sequences.
7521
ef6d912c
GM
7522** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
7523because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
7524
a933dad1
DL
7525** New function `propertize'
7526
7527The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
7528strings with text properties.
7529
7530- Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
7531
7532Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
7533by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
7534PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
7535specified value of that property. Example:
7536
7537 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
7538
a933dad1
DL
7539** push and pop macros.
7540
02b14400
RS
7541Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
7542are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
a933dad1
DL
7543as the place that holds the list to be changed.
7544
7545(push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
7546(pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
7547 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
7548
02b14400
RS
7549** New dolist and dotimes macros.
7550
6c7fd5aa
RS
7551Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
7552are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
02b14400
RS
7553
7554(dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
7555 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
7556 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
7557 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
7558
7559(dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
7560 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
7561 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
7562 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
7563
6c083b4c
GM
7564** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
7565[:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
7566class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
7567or a sign.
a933dad1
DL
7568
7569[:digit:] matches 0 through 9
7570[:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
7571[:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
7572[:blank:] matches space and tab only
7573[:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
7574 space, and DEL.
7575[:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
7576 and DEL.
7577[:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
7578 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7579 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7580[:alpha:] matches letters.
7581 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7582 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7583[:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
7584[:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
7585[:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
7586[:punct:] matches punctuation.
7587 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7588 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
7589[:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
7590[:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
7591[:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
7592
a933dad1
DL
7593** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
7594
7595The following functions are defined for hash tables:
7596
7597- Function: make-hash-table ARGS
7598
7599The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
7600are optional. The following arguments are defined:
7601
7602:test TEST
7603
7604TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
7605Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
7606it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
7607
7608:size SIZE
7609
7610SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
7611many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
7612
7613:rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
7614
7615REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
7616full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
7617size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
76181.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
7619old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
7620
7621:rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
7622
7623THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
7624hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
7625(size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
7626
7627:weakness WEAK
7628
b548072f
GM
7629WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
7630`key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
7631`key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
7632collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
7633outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
a933dad1
DL
7634
7635- Function: makehash &optional TEST
7636
7637Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
7638
7639- Function: hash-table-p TABLE
7640
7641Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
7642
7643- Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
7644
7645Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
7646values are shared.
7647
7648- Function: hash-table-count TABLE
7649
7650Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
7651
7652- Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
7653
7654Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
7655
7656- Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
7657
7658Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
7659
7660- Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
7661
7662Returns the size of TABLE.
7663
d96d6bb0 7664- Function: hash-table-test TABLE
a933dad1
DL
7665
7666Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
7667
7668- Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
7669
7670Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
7671
7672- Function: clrhash TABLE
7673
7674Clear TABLE.
7675
7676- Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
7677
7678Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
7679not found.
7680
79214ddf 7681- Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
a933dad1
DL
7682
7683Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
7684another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
7685
7686- Function: remhash KEY TABLE
7687
7688Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
7689
7690- Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
7691
7692Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
7693arguments KEY and VALUE.
7694
7695- Function: sxhash OBJ
7696
7697Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
7698
7699- Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
7700
7701Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
7702a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
79214ddf 7703comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
a933dad1
DL
7704and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
7705of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
7706
7707TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
7708
7709HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
7710code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
7711integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
7712
7713Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
7714be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
7715
7716 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
7717 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
7718
7719 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
7720 (sxhash (upcase a)))
7721
79214ddf 7722 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
a933dad1
DL
7723 'case-fold-string-hash))
7724
7725 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
7726
a933dad1
DL
7727** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
7728
7729It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
7730circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
7731a cons cell which is its own cdr.
7732
a933dad1
DL
7733** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
7734
7735If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
7736#N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
7737
a933dad1
DL
7738** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
7739t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
7740specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
7741is too short to reach that column.
7742
a933dad1
DL
7743** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
7744now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
7745after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
7746two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
7747
7748If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
7749perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
7750and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
7751
a933dad1
DL
7752** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
7753to specify which buffer to return the size of.
7754
a933dad1
DL
7755** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
7756calendar-move-hook after moving point.
7757
a933dad1
DL
7758** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
7759directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
7760small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
7761small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
7762temporary-file-directory instead.
7763
a933dad1
DL
7764** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
7765the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
7766`before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
7767hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
7768
2018166d
DL
7769** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
7770elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
a933dad1 7771
a933dad1
DL
7772** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
7773
7774make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
7775creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
7776ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
7777
a933dad1
DL
7778** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
7779
7780The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
7781on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
7782is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
7783never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
7784ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
7785overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
7786
7787If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
7788that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
7789to get an error if the file exists at that time.
7790The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
7791
a933dad1
DL
7792** Function `format' now handles text properties.
7793
7794Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
7795If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
7796ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
7797result string.
7798
7799Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
7800string where arguments appear in the result string.
7801
7802Example:
7803
7804 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
7805 (s2 "world"))
7806 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
7807 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
b246b1f6 7808 (format s1 s2))
a933dad1
DL
7809
7810results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
7811
a933dad1
DL
7812** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
7813
7814Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
7815The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
7816argument in it.
7817
7818 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
7819 (arg "world"))
7820 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
7821 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
7822 (message msg arg))
7823
a933dad1
DL
7824** Sound support
7825
7826Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
7827(Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
7828
7829Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
7830(*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
7831to enable sound support.
7832
7833Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
7834list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
7835when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
7836functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
7837sound to play, before playing the sound.
7838
7839The following sound properties are supported:
7840
7841- `:file FILE'
7842
7843FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
7844searched relative to `data-directory'.
7845
6fb40beb
GM
7846- `:data DATA'
7847
7848DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
7849may be present, but not both.
7850
a933dad1
DL
7851- `:volume VOLUME'
7852
7853VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
78540..1. This property is optional.
7855
01242779
DL
7856- `:device DEVICE'
7857
7858DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
7859sound. The default device is system-dependent.
7860
a933dad1
DL
7861Other properties are ignored.
7862
01242779
DL
7863An alternative interface is called as
7864(play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
7865
a933dad1 7866** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
356673d4
DL
7867
7868** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
7869a keyword symbol.
fc91dc2d
GM
7870
7871** Changes to garbage collection
7872
7873*** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
7874of live and free strings.
7875
7876*** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
7877strings that have been consed so far.
7878
05197f40 7879\f
04545643
GM
7880* Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
7881Lisp Manual
7882
a299a6f0
GM
7883** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
7884mini-windows.
7885
26fcde61
MB
7886** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
7887argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
7888returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
ea4c1b7c 7889
a299a6f0 7890** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
82a452c8 7891
9a8d84ca 7892** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
2c69ced2
GM
7893
7894** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
7895image.
7896
7897- Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
7898
7899Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
7900
7901SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
7902measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
7903character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
7904font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
7905FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
7906
ebb8f116
GM
7907** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
7908has a mask bitmap.
7909
7910- Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
7911
7912Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
7913FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
7914or omitted means use the selected frame.
7915
0b8a3a6d
DL
7916** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
7917satisfying one of a list of specifications.
7918
0b8a3a6d
DL
7919** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
7920optional.
7921
f6499c03
DL
7922** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
7923below).
04545643 7924
05197f40 7925\f
a933dad1
DL
7926* New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
7927
f6d3257b
GM
7928** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
7929to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
7930
7931Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
7932text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
7933is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
7934your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
7935laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
7936just display it black instead.
7937
7938This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
7939a line like
7940
7941 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
7942
7943in your `.emacs'.
7944
a933dad1
DL
7945** New face implementation.
7946
7947Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
7948font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
7949
a933dad1
DL
7950*** New faces.
7951
7952Each face can specify the following display attributes:
7953
7954 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
79214ddf 7955
a933dad1
DL
7956 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
7957 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
79214ddf 7958
a933dad1 7959 3. Font height in 1/10pt
79214ddf 7960
a933dad1 7961 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
79214ddf 7962
a933dad1 7963 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
79214ddf 7964
a933dad1 7965 6. Foreground color.
79214ddf 7966
a933dad1
DL
7967 7. Background color.
7968
7969 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
7970
7971 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
7972
7973 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
7974
7975 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
7976
7977 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
7978 color.
7979
7980 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
7981 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
7982
7983Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
7984same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
7985frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
7986faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
0969bd6a 7987with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
a933dad1
DL
7988attributes mentioned above.
7989
7990There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
7991definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
7992created frames.
79214ddf 7993
a933dad1
DL
7994A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
7995have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
7996`fully-specified'.
7997
a933dad1
DL
7998*** Face merging.
7999
8000The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
8001combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
8002aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
8003properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
8004that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
8005results in a fully-specified face.
8006
a933dad1
DL
8007*** Face realization.
8008
8009After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
8010merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
8011realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
8012available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
8013face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
8014cache of the frame on which it was realized.
8015
8016Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
8017character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
8018for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
8019charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
8020
8021Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
8022specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
8023being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
8024the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
8025statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
8026
8027In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
8028`char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
80290x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
8030the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
8031initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
8032Emacs.
8033
8034Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
8035`enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
8036registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
8037with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
8038
a933dad1
DL
8039**** Clearing face caches.
8040
8041The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
8042on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
8043unused fonts.
8044
a933dad1 8045*** Font selection.
79214ddf 8046
a933dad1
DL
8047Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
8048given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
8049for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
8050
8051If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
8052pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
8053family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
8054property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
8055an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
8056
8057Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
8058against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
8059match for the given face attributes in this font list.
8060
8061Font selection can be influenced by the user.
8062
8063The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
8064attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
8065face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
8066names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
8067that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
8068width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
8069to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
8070
52d89894
GM
8071Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8072alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
89d57763 8073doesn't exist.
af4bb4c8
KH
8074
8075Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8a33023e 8076all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
af4bb4c8
KH
8077registry.
8078
8a33023e 8079Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
af4bb4c8
KH
8080slightly different.
8081
8082Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
8083
a933dad1 8084
a933dad1
DL
8085**** Scalable fonts
8086
8087Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
8088since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
8089servers.
8090
8091To enable scalable font use, set the variable
b246b1f6 8092`scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
a933dad1
DL
8093scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
8094Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
8095scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
8096that list. Example:
8097
8098 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
8099
8100allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
8101
a933dad1
DL
8102*** Functions and variables related to font selection.
8103
8104- Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
8105
8106Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
8107is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
8108string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
8109
8110If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
8111the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
8112FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
8113POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
8114SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
8115These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
8116if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
8117REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
8118the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
8119of the face font sort order.
8120
79214ddf 8121- Function: x-font-family-list
a933dad1
DL
8122
8123Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
8124omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
8125(FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
8126non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
8127
8128- Variable: font-list-limit
8129
8130Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
8131won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
8132matching font. The default is currently 100.
8133
a933dad1
DL
8134*** Setting face attributes.
8135
8136For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
8137with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
8138implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
8139`face-attribute'.
8140
8141Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
8142symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
8143
8144The following attributes are recognized:
8145
8146`:family'
8147
8148VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
8149or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
8150and `?' are allowed.
8151
8152`:width'
8153
8154VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
8155It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
8156`condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
8157`extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
8158
8159`:height'
8160
787345ff
MB
8161VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
8162in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
8163scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
8164height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
a933dad1
DL
8165
8166`:weight'
8167
8168VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
8169symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
8170`semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
8171
8172`:slant'
8173
8174VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
8175symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
8176`reverse-oblique'.
8177
8178`:foreground', `:background'
8179
8180VALUE must be a color name, a string.
8181
8182`:underline'
8183
8184VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
8185VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
8186a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
8187don't underline.
8188
8189`:overline'
8190
8191VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
8192VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
8193string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
8194overline.
8195
8196`:strike-through'
8197
8198VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
8199striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
8200face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
8201is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
8202
8203`:box'
8204
8205VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
8206around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
8207VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
8208of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
8209and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
8210VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
8211:color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
8212the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
8213specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
8214defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
8215the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
8216color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
8217should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
8218like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
8219that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
8220the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
8221box.
8222
8223`:inverse-video'
8224
8225VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
8226inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
8227
8228`:stipple'
8229
8230If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
8231The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
8232searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
8233HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
8234is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
8235explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
8236
8237For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
8238and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
8239
8240`:font'
8241
8242Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
8243XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
8244is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
8245versions of Emacs.
8246
8247For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
8248be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
8249must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
8250
8251Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
8252`defface'.
8253
787345ff
MB
8254`:inherit'
8255
8256VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
8257of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
8258like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
8259
a933dad1
DL
8260*** Face attributes and X resources
8261
8262The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
8263from X resources:
8264
8265 Face attribute X resource class
8266-----------------------------------------------------------------------
8267 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
8268 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
8269 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
8270 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
8271 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
8272 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
8273 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
8274 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
8275 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
8276 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
8277 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
8278 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
8279 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
79214ddf 8280 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
a933dad1
DL
8281 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
8282 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8283 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
8284 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
8285 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8286
a933dad1
DL
8287*** Text property `face'.
8288
8289The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
8290specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
8291specification can be
8292
82931. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
8294
82952. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
8296 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
8297 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
8298 for face attribute names.
8299
83003. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
8301 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
8302 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
8303
a933dad1
DL
8304** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
8305
acf3ecb7
EZ
8306The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
8307on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
8308the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
a933dad1 8309default. You can get defined colors with a call to
acf3ecb7 8310`defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
a933dad1
DL
8311used to clear the mapping table.
8312
acf3ecb7
EZ
8313** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
8314
8315The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
8316and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
8317type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
8318color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
8319display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
8320old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
8321`x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
8322compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
8323should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
8324modify their color-related behavior.
8325
8326The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
8327any frame type.
8328
8a5719f0
EZ
8329** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
8330
8331The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
8332`display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
8333`display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
8334`display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
8335`display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
8336`display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
8337display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
8338the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
8339platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
8340
27009a49
EZ
8341The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
8342display can display image files.
8343
a933dad1 8344** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
a933dad1 8345
463cac2d 8346This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
3b51cca0
MB
8347To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
8348the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
8349`Inviolable' option.
a933dad1 8350
d586cf1e 8351The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
a933dad1 8352end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
d586cf1e 8353Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
a933dad1 8354
463cac2d
GM
8355** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
8356
8357There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
8358buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
59927f88 8359property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
463cac2d 8360
9a9dfda8 8361Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
463cac2d 8362forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
9a9dfda8 8363to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
463cac2d 8364not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
fc7ac24f
GM
8365commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
8366boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
8367`inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
8368functions.
463cac2d
GM
8369
8370Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
9a9dfda8 8371a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
463cac2d 8372editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
a933dad1 8373
9a9dfda8
GM
8374The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
8375
59927f88 8376- Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
9a9dfda8
GM
8377
8378Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
59927f88 8379
9a9dfda8
GM
8380A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8381If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
9b2a085d 8382constrained position if that is different.
9a9dfda8
GM
8383
8384If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
8385positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
8386ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
59927f88 8387constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
9a9dfda8
GM
8388as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8389is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
59927f88
MB
8390fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
8391the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
8392also considered to be `on the boundary'.
9a9dfda8
GM
8393
8394If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
8395NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
8396unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
8397C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
8398only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
8399
59927f88
MB
8400If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
8401a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
8402
8403Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
8404
8405- Function: delete-field &optional POS
9a9dfda8 8406
59927f88 8407Delete the field surrounding POS.
9a9dfda8 8408A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
59927f88 8409If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9a9dfda8
GM
8410
8411- Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8412
8413Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
8414A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
59927f88
MB
8415If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8416If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
9a9dfda8
GM
8417field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
8418
8419- Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8420
8421Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
8422A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
59927f88
MB
8423If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8424If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
9a9dfda8
GM
8425then the end of the *following* field is returned.
8426
8427- Function: field-string &optional POS
8428
8429Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
8430A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
59927f88 8431If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9a9dfda8
GM
8432
8433- Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
8434
8435Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
8436A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
59927f88 8437If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9a9dfda8 8438
a933dad1
DL
8439** Image support.
8440
8441Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
8442strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
8443(AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
8444replaces the display of the characters having that property.
8445
8446If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
8447`(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
8448AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
8449window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
8450area.
8451
8452IMAGE is an image specification.
8453
8454*** Image specifications
8455
8456Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
8457is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
8458specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
35a5514b
GM
8459symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
8460described below are ignored.
a933dad1
DL
8461
8462The following is a list of properties all image types share.
8463
8464`:ascent ASCENT'
8465
576da55d
GM
8466ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
8467If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
5d94f558 8468to use for its ascent.
576da55d
GM
8469
8470If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
8471image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
8472
5d94f558 8473If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
04545643
GM
8474centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
8475of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
8476overlays that apply to the image.
a933dad1
DL
8477
8478`:margin MARGIN'
8479
b30623be
GM
8480MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
8481as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
8482horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
a933dad1
DL
8483
8484`:relief RELIEF'
8485
8486RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
8487around an image.
8488
f864120f 8489`:conversion ALGO'
a933dad1 8490
47e351a3
GM
8491Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
8492
8493ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
8494edge-detection algorithm to the image.
8495
8496ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
8497apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
8498nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
8499position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
8500around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
8501neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
8502transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
8503x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
8504below.
8505
8506 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
8507 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
8508 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
8509
8510The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
8511resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
8512multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
8513of the factors' absolute values.
8514
327652be 8515Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
a933dad1 8516
47e351a3
GM
8517 (1 0 0
8518 0 0 0
8519 9 9 -1)
8520
8521Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
8522
8523 ( 2 -1 0
8524 -1 0 1
8525 0 1 -2)
8526
ba9eeda1
GM
8527ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
8528``disabled''.
8529
47e351a3
GM
8530`:mask MASK'
8531
8532If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
8533the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
8534image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
8535background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
8a33023e 8536image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
47e351a3
GM
8537the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
8538GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
8539image.
a933dad1 8540
47e351a3
GM
8541If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
8542in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
8543`:mask nil'.
a933dad1
DL
8544
8545`:file FILE'
8546
8547Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
8548search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
8549building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
8550may be present in the image specification.
8551
518df5c4
GM
8552`:data DATA'
8553
8554Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
8555supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
8556present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
8557support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
8558
a933dad1
DL
8559*** Supported image types
8560
b246b1f6 8561**** XBM, image type `xbm'.
a933dad1
DL
8562
8563XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
0e467b97 8564properties supported are:
a933dad1
DL
8565
8566`:foreground FG'
8567
94736c7c 8568FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
0e467b97 8569meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
a933dad1 8570
46c5af7f 8571`:background BG'
a933dad1 8572
0e467b97 8573BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
94736c7c 8574meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
a933dad1
DL
8575
8576XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
8577case, the image specification must contain the following properties
8578instead of a `:file' property.
8579
8580`:width WIDTH'
8581
8582WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
8583
8584`:height HEIGHT'
8585
8586HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
8587
8588`:data DATA'
8589
8590DATA must be either
8591
8592 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
8593 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
8594
8595 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
8596
8597 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
8598 bitmap.
8599
c76e04a8
GM
8600 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
8601 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
8602 in the file.
8603
a933dad1
DL
8604**** XPM, image type `xpm'
8605
8606XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
8607`xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
8608found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
8609`--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
8610
8611Additional image properties supported are:
8612
8613`:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
8614
8615SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
8616name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
8617name.
8618
8619XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
8620add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
8621
a933dad1
DL
8622The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
8623to display compressed images.
8624
8625**** PBM, image type `pbm'
8626
8627PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
2b8e9c91 8628mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
0e467b97 8629mono images are:
2b8e9c91
GM
8630
8631`:foreground FG'
8632
94736c7c 8633FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
0e467b97 8634meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
2b8e9c91
GM
8635
8636`:background FG'
8637
0e467b97 8638BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
94736c7c 8639meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
a933dad1
DL
8640
8641**** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
8642
8643Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
0e467b97
JB
8644package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8645properties defined.
3bd37feb 8646
a933dad1
DL
8647**** TIFF, image type `tiff'
8648
8649Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
8650package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8651properties defined.
8652
8653**** GIF, image type `gif'
8654
8655Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
8656`libungif-4.1.0', or later.
8657
8658Additional image properties supported are:
8659
8660`:index INDEX'
8661
8662INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
ca205aa3
RS
8663multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
8664as a hollow box.
a933dad1
DL
8665
8666This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
8667For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
8668at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
8669every 0.1 seconds.
8670
8671(defun show-anim (file max)
8672 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
8673 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
8674
8675(defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
8676 (when (= idx max)
8677 (setq idx 0))
518df5c4 8678 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
a933dad1
DL
8679 (save-excursion
8680 (set-buffer buffer)
8681 (goto-char (point-min))
8682 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
8683 (insert-image img "x"))
8684 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
8685
8686**** PNG, image type `png'
8687
8688Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
8689package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8690properties defined.
8691
8692**** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
8693
8694Additional image properties supported are:
8695
8696`:pt-width WIDTH'
8697
8698WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
b246b1f6 8699integer. This is a required property.
a933dad1
DL
8700
8701`:pt-height HEIGHT'
8702
8703HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
b246b1f6 8704must be a integer. This is an required property.
a933dad1
DL
8705
8706`:bounding-box BOX'
8707
8708BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
8709the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
8710files. This is an required property.
8711
8712Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
8713lisp/gs.el.
8714
8715*** Lisp interface.
8716
79214ddf
FP
8717The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
8718which are supported in the current configuration.
a933dad1
DL
8719
8720Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
8721they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
8722The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
084cec2f
GM
8723manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
8724images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
a933dad1
DL
8725
8726*** Simplified image API, image.el
8727
8728The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
8729creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
8730can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
8731define an image based on available image types. The functions
8732`put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
8733buffer.
8734
a933dad1
DL
8735** Display margins.
8736
8737Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
8738and images.
8739
8740To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
8741`left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
8742`set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
8743obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
8744`right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
8745the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
8746of the display margins.
8747
8748You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
8749containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
8750one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
8751string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
8752in this file).
8753
a933dad1
DL
8754** Help display
8755
8756Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
8757moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
8758`help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
8759that have a `help-echo' property.
8760
9662da0b 8761If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
85a8aca9 8762is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
c20aeb83
GM
8763the window in which the help was found.
8764
8765If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
8766`help-echo' text property was found.
8767
8768If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
8769POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
8770
8771If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
5ed8d5af 8772the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
c20aeb83 8773mouse.
d5aa31d8 8774
9662da0b
GM
8775If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
8776string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
8777
8778For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
8779determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
8780property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
8781For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
8782used as help string.
a933dad1
DL
8783
8784The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
f0298744
DL
8785the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
8786causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
a933dad1 8787
a933dad1
DL
8788** Vertical fractional scrolling.
8789
8790The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
8791This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
8792
8793The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
8794scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
8795The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
8796scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
8797used.
8798
79214ddf
FP
8799 (global-set-key [A-down]
8800 #'(lambda ()
a933dad1 8801 (interactive)
79214ddf 8802 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
a933dad1 8803 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
79214ddf 8804 (global-set-key [A-up]
a933dad1
DL
8805 #'(lambda ()
8806 (interactive)
79214ddf 8807 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
a933dad1
DL
8808 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
8809
a933dad1
DL
8810** New hook `fontification-functions'.
8811
8812Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
8813when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
8814variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
8815is called with one argument, POS.
8816
8817At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
8818characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
8819as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
8820property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
8821`fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
8822
a933dad1
DL
8823** Tool bar support.
8824
8825Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
8826parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
8827controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
8828suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
8829`auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
8830automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
8831
8832*** Tool bar item definitions
8833
8834Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
8835`tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
8836where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
79214ddf 8837
a933dad1
DL
8838CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
8839evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
8840the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
8841property (see below).
79214ddf 8842
a933dad1
DL
8843BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
8844binding are currently ignored.
8845
8846The following properties are recognized:
8847
8848`:enable FORM'.
79214ddf 8849
a933dad1
DL
8850FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
8851or disabled.
79214ddf 8852
a933dad1 8853`:visible FORM'
79214ddf 8854
a933dad1 8855FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
79214ddf 8856
a933dad1
DL
8857`:filter FUNCTION'
8858
8859FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
8860FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
8861used instead of BINDING to display this item.
79214ddf 8862
a933dad1
DL
8863`:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
8864
8865TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
8866and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
79214ddf 8867
a933dad1
DL
8868`:image IMAGES'
8869
8870IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
8871image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
8872meaning of each of the four elements:
8873
8874 Index Use when item is
8875 ----------------------------------------
8876 0 enabled and selected
8877 1 enabled and deselected
8878 2 disabled and selected
8879 3 disabled and deselected
79214ddf 8880
4ba7246d
GM
8881If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
8882algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
8883
a933dad1 8884`:help HELP-STRING'.
79214ddf 8885
a933dad1
DL
8886Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
8887is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
8888
dab96841 8889The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
d1e68bce
DL
8890toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
8891to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
8892menu bar.
dab96841 8893
8628686a
DL
8894The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
8895dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
8896buffer-locally to override the global map.
8897
a933dad1
DL
8898*** Tool-bar-related variables.
8899
8900If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
8901resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
8902than 1/4 of the frame's size.
8903
79214ddf 8904If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
a933dad1
DL
8905raised when the mouse moves over them.
8906
8907You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
8908`tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
b30623be
GM
8909pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
8910vertical margins . Default is 1.
a933dad1
DL
8911
8912You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
8913`tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
8914
8915*** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
8916
8917You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
79214ddf 8918a tool bar item. If
a933dad1
DL
8919
8920 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
8921 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
8922 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
8923
8924is the original tool bar item definition, then
8925
8926 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
8927
8928makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
8929item.
8930
8931** Mode line changes.
8932
a933dad1
DL
8933*** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
8934
8935The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
8936that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
8937a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
8938
89391. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
8940a `local-map' text property.
8941
89422. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
8943that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
8944
89453. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
8946is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
8947`local-map' property.
8948
8949The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
8950properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
8951example.
8952
54522c9f
GM
8953*** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
8954evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
8955
a933dad1
DL
8956*** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
8957variable mode-line-format to nil.
8958
a933dad1
DL
8959*** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
8960
8961This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
8962`header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
8963completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
8964`default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
8965line.
8966
8967The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
8968`header-line'.
8969
8970The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
8971position in the header-line.
8972
a933dad1
DL
8973** Text property `display'
8974
623a0aae
GM
8975The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
8976replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
8977also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
8978the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
a933dad1
DL
8979below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
8980
623a0aae
GM
8981*** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
8982
8983To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
8984text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
8985
8986If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
8987marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
8988the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
8989is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
8990simpler form STRING as property value.
8991
a933dad1
DL
8992*** Variable width and height spaces
8993
8994To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
8995specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
8996`(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
8997area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
8998marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
8999displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9000simpler form STRETCH as property value.
9001
9002The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
9003PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
9004properties described below.
9005
9006The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
9007characters having the `display' property.
9008
9009- :width WIDTH
9010
9011Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
9012character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
9013
9014- :relative-width FACTOR
9015
9016Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
9017first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
9018same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
9019width of that character by FACTOR.
9020
9021- :align-to HPOS
9022
9023Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
9024value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
9025
9026Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
9027
9028- :height HEIGHT
9029
9030Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
9031normal line height.
9032
9033- :relative-height FACTOR
9034
9035The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
9036of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
9037
9038- :ascent ASCENT
9039
9040Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
9041used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
9042baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
9043equal to 100.
9044
9045You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
9046
9047*** Images
9048
9049A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
9050. IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
9051in the display, the characters having this display specification in
9052their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
9053the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
9054`(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
9055area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
9056the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
9057as display specification.
9058
9059*** Other display properties
9060
c9e73000 9061- (space-width FACTOR)
a933dad1
DL
9062
9063Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
9064should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
9065integer or float.
9066
c9e73000 9067- (height HEIGHT)
a933dad1
DL
9068
9069Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
9070
9071If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
9072means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
9073the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
9074``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
9075a font is available counts as a step.
9076
9077If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
9078as tall as the frame's default font.
9079
9080If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
9081height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
9082
9083Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
9084`height' bound to the current specified font height.
9085
c9e73000 9086- (raise FACTOR)
a933dad1
DL
9087
9088FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
9089font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
9090raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
9091amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
c9e73000 9092`height' subproperty.
a933dad1
DL
9093
9094*** Conditional display properties
9095
9096All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
6c6caea2
GM
9097has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
9098only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
9099evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
9100conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
9101bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
9102the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
9103different when object is a string.
a933dad1
DL
9104
9105The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
6c6caea2 9106`(when t . SPEC)'.
a933dad1 9107
a933dad1
DL
9108** New menu separator types.
9109
9110Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
9111item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
9112treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
9113to specify other menu separator types.
9114
9115- `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
9116
9117No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
9118separator occurs.
9119
9120- `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
9121
9122A single line in the menu's foreground color.
9123
9124- `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
9125
9126A double line in the menu's foreground color.
9127
9128- `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
9129
9130A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9131
9132- `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
9133
9134A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9135
9136- `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
9137
f3780fe4 9138A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
a933dad1
DL
9139displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
9140
9141- `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
9142
9143A single line with 3D raised appearance.
9144
9145- `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
9146
9147A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
9148
9149- `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
9150
9151A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
9152
9153- `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
9154
9155Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9156
9157- `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
9158
9159Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
9160
9161- `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
9162
9163Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9164
9165- `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
9166
9167Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
9168
9169Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
9170the corresponding single-line separators.
9171
a933dad1
DL
9172** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
9173
9174The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
9175`scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
9176Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
9177that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
9178default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
9179default background is the background color of the frame, and the
9180default foreground is black.
9181
9182The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
9183(class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
9184`ScrollBarBackground').
9185
9186Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
9187settings for scroll bar colors.
9188
a933dad1
DL
9189** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
9190display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
9191
a933dad1
DL
9192** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
9193starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
9194on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
9195line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
9196the original window start.
9197
a933dad1
DL
9198** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
9199`hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
9200now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
9201
a933dad1
DL
9202** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
9203
9204A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
9205`window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
9206windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
9207other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
9208
9209The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
9210fixed-width and fixed-height.
9211
9212 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
9213
9214A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
9215fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
9216window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
9217change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
9218temporarily to nil, for example
9219
9220 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
9221 (enlarge-window 10))
9222
79214ddf 9223Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
a933dad1 9224or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
e411ce4b
EZ
9225
9226** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
9227terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
9228to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
9229overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
9230horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
9231support a vertical-bar cursor).
76299050 9232
3787e12e 9233
05197f40 9234\f
3787e12e
GM
9235* Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
9236
9237** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
9238input.
9239
9240** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
9241
9242** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
9243
9244** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
9245only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
9246exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
9247(e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
9248(e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
9249
9250** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
9251been added.
9252
05197f40 9253\f
3787e12e
GM
9254* Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
9255
9256** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
9257
0cb146bf 9258
05197f40 9259\f
3787e12e
GM
9260* Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
9261
9262** Not new, but not mentioned before:
9263M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
05197f40 9264\f
3787e12e
GM
9265* Changes in Emacs 20.4
9266
9267** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
9268
9269You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
9270Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
9271`.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
9272
9273If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
9274is the one that is used.
9275
9276** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
9277the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
9278Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
9279separate from the command's regular output.
9280Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
9281says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
9282In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
9283the buffer name.
9284
9285When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
9286output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
9287it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
9288cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
9289
9290** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
9291the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
9292is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
9293created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
9294
9295** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
9296example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
9297match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
9298quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
9299
9300** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
9301now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
9302if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
9303they never ignore case.
9304
9305** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
9306under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
9307applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
9308of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
9309just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
9310convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
9311part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
9312
9313If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
9314the same format that was used in the file before.
9315
9316You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
9317`inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
9318
9319** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
9320renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
9321This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
9322
9323** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
9324The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
9325buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
9326your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
9327is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
9328end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
9329Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
9330
9331The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
9332eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
9333control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
9334format. You can now customize these variables.
9335
9336** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
9337filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
9338filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
9339enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
9340
9341** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
9342in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
9343windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
9344
9345** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
9346dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
9347doesn't have any effect.
9348
9349** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
9350not one per buffer.
9351
9352** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
9353use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
9354 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
9355
9356** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
9357To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
9358`auto-show-mode' command.
9359
9360** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
9361avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
9362versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
9363choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
9364occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
9365
9366** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
9367cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
9368
9369** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
9370character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
9371feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
9372
9373** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
9374the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
9375interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
9376and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
9377
9378** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
9379
9380The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
9381that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
9382one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
9383codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
9384set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
9385
9386Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
9387from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
9388
9389IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
9390equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
9391a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
9392`?' on other systems.
9393
9394IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
9395feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
9396Unix.
9397
9398Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
9399current codepage when it starts.
9400
9401** Mail changes
9402
9403*** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
9404`mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
9405appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
9406non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
9407MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
9408headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
9409latin-1:
9410
9411 MIME-version: 1.0
9412 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
9413 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
9414
9415*** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
9416default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
9417default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
9418sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
9419buffer-file-coding-system.
9420
9421You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
9422sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
9423mail.
9424
9425*** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
9426if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
9427Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
9428list of possible coding systems.
9429
9430** CC Mode changes
9431
9432*** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
9433modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
9434longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
9435docstring for details.
9436
9437*** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
9438symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
9439found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
9440prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
9441lineup functions use this feature currently.
9442
9443*** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
9444"finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
9445
9446*** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
9447"catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
9448
9449*** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
9450from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
9451symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
9452c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
9453anonymous classes.
9454
9455*** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
9456syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
9457
9458*** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
9459inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
9460support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
9461function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
9462
9463*** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
9464(i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
9465brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
9466c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
9467(brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
9468
9469*** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
9470
9471*** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
9472
9473*** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
9474for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
9475
9476*** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
9477
9478*** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
9479associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
9480This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
9481circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
9482class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
9483
9484** Gnus changes.
9485
9486*** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
9487added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
9488Gnus manual for the full story.
9489
9490*** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
9491before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
9492group, which is created automatically.
9493
9494*** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
9495values.
9496
9497*** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
9498
9499*** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
9500outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
9501
9502*** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
9503`C-u C-c C-c'.
9504
9505*** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
9506
9507*** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
9508re-highlighting of the article buffer.
9509
9510*** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
9511
9512*** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
9513Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
9514
9515*** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
9516`a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
9517
9518*** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
9519control over simplification.
9520
9521*** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
9522
9523*** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
9524limit.
9525
9526*** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
9527
9528*** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
9529
9530*** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
9531If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
9532rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
9533
8a33023e 9534*** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
3787e12e
GM
9535`a' forces normal posting method.
9536
9537*** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
9538-- `W d'.
9539
9540*** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
9541to a non-nil value.
9542
9543*** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
9544where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
9545
9546*** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
9547has been added.
9548
9549*** A history of where mails have been split is available.
9550
9551*** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
9552
9553*** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
9554`gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
9555
9556*** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
9557`message-cite-original-without-signature'.
9558
9559*** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
9560
9561*** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
9562been added.
9563
9564*** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
9565`gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
9566
9567*** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
9568updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
9569
9570*** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
9571
9572*** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
9573
9574*** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
9575
9576** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
9577
9578*** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
9579options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
9580nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
9581
9582*** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
9583TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
9584of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
9585TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
9586can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
9587
9588*** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
9589All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
9590but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
9591the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
9592
9593*** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
9594the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
9595buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
9596mismatch.
9597
9598** Changes to RefTeX mode
9599
9600*** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
9601file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
9602
9603*** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
9604lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
9605characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
9606removed from the label.
9607
9608*** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
9609a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
9610
9611*** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
9612customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
9613
9614*** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
9615`reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
9616expressions.
9617
9618*** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
9619
9620** New/deleted modes and packages
9621
9622*** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
9623SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
9624
9625*** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
9626editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
9627SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
9628
9629*** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
9630changes with a special face.
9631
9632*** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
9633this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
9634Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
05197f40 9635\f
3787e12e
GM
9636* MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
9637
9638** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
9639This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
9640conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
9641and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
9642check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
9643
9644The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
9645Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
9646distribution when the config.bat script is run.
9647
9648** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
9649MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
9650controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
9651directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
9652Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
9653on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
9654string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
9655program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
9656printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
9657
9658** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
9659output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
9660available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
9661input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
9662temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
9663program.
9664
9665An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
9666and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
9667programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
9668automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
9669as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
9670ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
9671
9672** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
9673a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
9674MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
9675was not documented clearly before.
9676
9677** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
9678This includes Tetris and Snake.
05197f40 9679\f
3787e12e
GM
9680* Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
9681
9682** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
9683return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
9684They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
9685meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
9686
9687** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
9688WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
9689and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
9690
9691** Changes in the file-attributes function.
9692
9693*** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
9694It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
9695
9696*** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
9697the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
9698integers.
9699
9700** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
9701files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
9702arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
9703file names and attributes are returned.
9704
9705** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
9706sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
8a33023e 9707accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
3787e12e
GM
9708It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
9709returns the result.
9710
9711** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
9712to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
9713
9714** New functions for base64 conversion:
9715
9716The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
9717into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
9718performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
9719optionally.
9720
9721Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
9722job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
9723
9724**
9725The new function process-running-child-p
9726will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
9727terminal to its own child process.
9728
9729** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
9730when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
9731to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
9732itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
9733
9734** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
9735be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
9736
4a389f53 9737** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
3787e12e
GM
9738:included is an alias for :visible.
9739
9740easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
9741easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
9742to move or copy menu entries.
9743
9744** Multibyte editing changes
9745
9746*** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
9747an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
9748make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
9749work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
9750char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
9751 (setq char (sref str idx)
9752 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
9753The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
9754
9755If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
9756(say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
9757 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
9758
9759*** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
9760region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
9761deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
9762
8a33023e 9763 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
3787e12e
GM
9764
9765This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
9766across the boundary.
9767
9768*** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
9769`unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
9770 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
9771 contains 8-bit characters.
9772 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
9773 contains invalid characters.
9774
9775*** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
9776text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
9777preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
9778text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
9779way.
9780
9781*** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
9782If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
9783end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
9784prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
9785
9786*** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
9787compose Thai characters in a string.
9788
9789** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
9790argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
9791for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
9792menus should always use the third argument.
9793
9794** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
9795read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
9796arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
9797input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
9798
9799** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
9800of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
9801programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
9802inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
9803
9804** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
9805the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
9806returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
9807echo area contents.
9808
9809 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
9810
9811** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
9812NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
9813requested feature cannot be loaded.
9814
9815** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
9816foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
9817means to clear out that attribute.
9818
9819** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
9820gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
9821
9822** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
9823read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
9824unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
9825end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
9826
9827** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
9828the gap of the current buffer.
9829
9830** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
9831to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
9832current buffer.
9833
9834** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
9835facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
9836These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
9837it back in after any modifications have been made.
05197f40 9838\f
3787e12e
GM
9839* Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
9840
9841** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
9842the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
9843/usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
9844directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
9845subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
9846
9847Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
9848names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
9849Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
9850which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
9851these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
9852
9853Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
9854starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
9855time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
9856
9857This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
9858Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
9859to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
9860subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
9861`.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
9862results.
9863
9864** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
9865GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
9866that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
9867fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
05197f40 9868\f
3787e12e
GM
9869* Changes in Emacs 20.3
9870
9871** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
9872including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
9873it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
9874perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
9875
9876** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
9877specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
9878region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
9879further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
9880command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
9881within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
9882are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
9883region.
9884
9885In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
9886selective undo.
9887
9888** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
9889unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
9890buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
9891effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
9892Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
9893
9894The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
9895though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
9896-*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
9897load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
9898
9899** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
9900no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
9901enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
9902something that most users not do.
9903
9904** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
9905operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
9906The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
9907applications.
9908
9909C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
9910pasting operations.
9911
9912** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
9913setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
9914like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
9915printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
9916`ps-printer-name'.
9917
9918** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
9919minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
9920any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
9921except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
9922incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
9923hits a new word.
9924
9925Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
9926Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
9927to be confused by TeX commands.
9928
9929You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
9930correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
9931clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
9932of various alternative replacements and actions.
9933
9934Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
9935the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
9936corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
9937alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
9938flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
9939
9940Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
9941flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
9942
9943** Changes in input method usage.
9944
9945Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
9946the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
9947respectively.
9948
9949You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
9950
9951If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
9952of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
9953
9954The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
9955that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
9956
9957 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
9958
9959 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
9960
9961 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
9962 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
9963
9964 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
9965 given in the following case:
9966 o When you are using a complex input method.
9967 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
9968
9969If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
9970input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
9971and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
9972setting it to t is helpful.
9973
9974The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
9975
9976In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
9977keys:
9978 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
9979 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
9980 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
9981These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
9982environment.
9983
9984** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
9985names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
9986minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
9987get
9988
9989 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
9990
9991which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
9992
9993Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
9994Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
9995
9996** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
9997at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
9998its owner and group.
9999
10000** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
10001Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
10002
10003** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
10004contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
10005
10006** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
10007which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
10008in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
10009by the left edge of the rectangle.
10010
10011** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
10012increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
10013C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
10014for writing keyboard macros.
10015
10016** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
10017files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
10018frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
10019the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
10020additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
10021info.
10022
10023** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
10024
10025** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
10026query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
10027contents only.
10028
10029** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
10030confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
10031the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
10032says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
10033
10034** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
10035non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
10036literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
10037
10038** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
10039now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
10040Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
10041inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
10042
10043** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
10044failure if the command produces no output.
10045
10046** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
10047manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
10048the mouse.
10049
10050** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
10051mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
10052function and variable names.
10053
10054** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
10055reading specific files. This has higher priority than
10056file-coding-system-alist.
10057
10058** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
10059t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
10060converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
10061the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
10062according to the current fontset.
10063
10064** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
10065
10066The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
10067that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
10068nonascii-insert-offset.
10069
10070For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
10071enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
10072nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
10073characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
10074
10075** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
10076an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
10077
10078** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
10079letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
10080
10081** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
10082are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
10083command keys.
10084
10085** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
10086user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
10087
10088Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
10089user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
10090all variables that have documentation.
10091
10092** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
10093shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
10094that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
10095minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
10096it should show; the default is 20.
10097
10098Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
10099the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
10100of your input.
10101
10102** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
10103all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
10104recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
10105argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
10106the customizable options which were changed since that version.
10107Newly added options are included as well.
10108
10109If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
10110then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
10111for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
10112
10113This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
10114Customize menu.
10115
10116** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
10117the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
10118
10119** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
10120buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
10121invoked.
10122
10123** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
10124that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
10125The default is 1.
10126
10127** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
10128syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
10129new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
10130(C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
10131sensibly.
10132
10133** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
10134
10135** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
10136value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
10137two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
10138
10139** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
10140reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
10141for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
10142every night.
10143
10144** Desktop changes
10145
10146*** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
10147the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
10148
10149*** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
10150and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
10151
10152** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
10153read and post multi-lingual articles.
10154
10155** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
10156doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
10157be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
10158outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
10159the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
10160made invisible again.
10161
10162** Mail reading and sending changes
10163
10164*** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
10165the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
10166changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
10167toggle.
10168
10169*** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
10170now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
10171summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
10172the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
10173rmail-default-body-file.
10174
10175*** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
10176longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
10177handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
10178
10179*** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
10180it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
10181is evaluated to insert the signature.
10182
10183*** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
10184outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
10185handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
10186putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
10187transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
10188especially interested in trying feedmail.
10189
10190feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
10191feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
10192provided by feedmail are:
10193
10194**** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
10195stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
10196there is also a queue for draft messages
10197
10198**** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
10199be prompted for confirmation
10200
10201**** does smart filling of address headers
10202
10203**** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
10204the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
10205can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
10206
10207**** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
10208the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
10209/usr/lib/sendmail, and elisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
10210function for something else (10-20 lines of elisp)
10211
10212** Dired changes
10213
10214*** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
10215files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
10216
10217*** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
10218run Dired on the directory name at point.
10219
10220*** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
10221files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
10222for a specified regexp.
10223
10224** VC Changes
10225
10226*** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
10227conveniently.
10228
10229*** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
10230faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
10231Dired.
10232
10233VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
10234directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
10235listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
10236currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
10237
10238You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
10239then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
10240vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
10241control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
10242on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
10243
10244All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
10245is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
10246`v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
10247the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
10248`vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
10249
10250The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
10251toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
10252VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
10253`* l', to mark all files currently locked.
10254
10255Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
10256ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
10257command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
10258
10259*** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
10260file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
10261session to resolve them.
10262
10263Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
10264resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
10265contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
10266uses as well).
10267
10268*** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
10269command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
10270you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
10271either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
10272branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
10273If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
10274using ediff.
10275
10276** Changes in Font Lock
10277
10278*** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
10279are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
10280use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
10281unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
10282compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
10283
10284** Frame name display changes
10285
10286*** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
10287frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
10288raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
10289when many frames are invisible or iconified.
10290
10291*** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
10292frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
10293menu.
10294
10295** Comint (subshell) changes
10296
10297*** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
10298subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
10299with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
10300
10301*** There are new commands in Comint mode.
10302
10303C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
10304that is, the line after the last line you got.
10305You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
10306
10307C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
10308send the current line together with the following line, when you send
10309the following line.
10310
10311C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
10312which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
10313previously sent input.
10314
10315C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
10316it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
10317as the search string.
10318
10319*** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
10320automatically in compilation-mode windows.
10321
10322** C mode changes
10323
10324*** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
10325and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
10326assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
10327definition.
10328
10329*** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
10330(i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
10331Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
10332style is still the default however.
10333
10334*** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
10335
10336*** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
10337are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
10338them. They do not have key bindings by default.
10339
10340*** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
10341and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
10342
10343*** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
10344namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
10345
10346*** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
10347makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
10348
10349*** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
10350c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
10351
10352*** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
10353should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
10354package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
10355variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
10356
10357** Changes to hippie-expand.
10358
10359*** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
10360non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
10361which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
10362
10363*** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
10364non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
10365expanding dynamically.
10366
10367*** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
10368non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
10369
10370*** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
10371non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
10372this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
10373expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
10374
10375*** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
10376
10377** Changes in BibTeX mode.
10378
10379*** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
10380bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
10381automatic key generation. This replaces variable
10382bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
10383against the first word in the title.
10384
10385*** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
10386capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
10387bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
10388lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
10389lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
10390bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
10391
10392*** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
10393generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
10394replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
10395bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
10396
10397** Changes in vcursor.el.
10398
10399*** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
10400and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
10401variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
10402entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
10403`vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
10404in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
10405
10406*** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
10407Editing group once the package is loaded.
10408
10409*** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
10410generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
8a33023e 10411vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
3787e12e
GM
10412
10413*** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
10414vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
10415
10416** Ispell changes.
10417
10418*** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
10419buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
10420are identified by syntax tables in effect.
10421
10422*** Generic region skipping implemented.
10423A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
10424and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
10425defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
10426include:
10427
10428 o URLs are automatically skipped
10429 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
10430
10431*** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
10432
10433** Changes to RefTeX mode
10434
10435RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
10436large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
10437re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
10438section `Optimizations' in the manual.
10439
10440*** New recursive parser.
10441
10442The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
10443entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
10444recursive parser scans the individual files.
10445
10446*** Parsing only part of a document.
10447
10448Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
10449partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
10450the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
10451
10452 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
10453
10454*** Storing parsing information in a file.
10455
10456This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
10457
10458 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
10459
10460*** Using multiple selection buffers
10461
10462If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
10463for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
10464
10465 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
10466
10467*** References to external documents.
10468
10469The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
10470documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
10471documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
10472macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
10473RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
10474the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
10475The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
10476
10477*** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
10478
8a33023e 10479The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
3787e12e
GM
10480and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
10481
10482Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
10483the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
10484
10485*** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
10486
10487The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
10488buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
10489
10490*** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
10491
10492The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
10493contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
10494`reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
10495have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
10496enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
10497at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
10498more.
10499
10500*** Support for the varioref package
10501
10502The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
10503
10504*** New hooks
10505
10506Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
10507and citations are created. These hooks are
10508`reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
10509`reftex-format-cite-function'.
10510
10511*** Citations outside LaTeX
10512
10513The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
10514a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
10515
10516*** Short context is no longer fontified.
10517
10518The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
10519fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
10520fontified, use
10521
10522 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
10523
10524** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
10525With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
10526the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
10527directories that contain the same file name.
10528
10529Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
10530Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
10531file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
10532Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
10533have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
10534names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
10535directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
10536directory.
10537
10538** New modes and packages
10539
10540*** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
10541It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
10542it, but some do not.
10543
10544*** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
10545code.
10546
10547*** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
10548current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
10549around in a buffer.
10550
10551Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
10552
10553*** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
10554uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
10555be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
10556established system of notation similar to Chess.
10557
10558*** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
10559documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
10560guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
10561
10562*** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
10563available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
10564system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
10565simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
10566functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
10567the like.
10568
10569*** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
10570identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
10571
10572*** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
10573within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
10574used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
10575the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
10576
10577*** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
10578
10579 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
10580 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
10581 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
10582 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
10583 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
10584 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
10585 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
10586 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
10587 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
10588 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
10589 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
10590
10591 Platform-specific modes:
10592
10593 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
10594 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
10595 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
10596 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
10597 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
10598 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
10599 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
10600 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
10601 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
05197f40 10602\f
3787e12e
GM
10603* Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
10604
10605** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
10606use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
10607That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
10608Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
10609
10610Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
10611you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
10612consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
10613
10614** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
10615and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
10616specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
10617searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
10618
10619** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
10620multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
10621character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
10622environment.
10623
10624** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
10625take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
10626string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
10627current input method for reading this one event.
10628
10629** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
10630now control whether to output certain characters as
10631backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
10632non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
10633characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
10634in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
05197f40 10635\f
3787e12e
GM
10636* Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
10637
10638** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
10639of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
10640
10641** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
10642in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
10643always increases point by 1.
10644
10645The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
10646considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
10647
10648See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
10649
10650** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
10651Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
10652default value changed. For example,
10653
10654 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
10655 :type 'integer
10656 :group 'foo
10657 :version "20.3")
10658
10659 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
10660 :version "20.3")
10661
10662If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
10663default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
10664is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
10665`:version' in the top level group.
10666
10667This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
10668
10669** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
10670starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
10671
10672However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
10673symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
10674support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
10675to themselves.
10676
10677If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
10678this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
10679values whatever.
10680
10681** There is a new debugger command, R.
10682It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
10683in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
10684
10685** Frame-local variables.
10686
10687You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
10688the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
10689local bindings for that variable.
10690
10691These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
10692frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
10693modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
10694parameter name.
10695
10696Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
10697Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
10698active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
10699that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
10700
10701It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
10702clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
10703very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
10704through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
10705
10706** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
10707"symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
10708evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
10709makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
10710See the documentation in sregex.el.
10711
10712** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
10713is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
10714parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
10715The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
10716
10717** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
10718If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
10719
10720** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
10721known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
10722define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
10723
10724** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
10725when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
10726it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
10727history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
10728
10729The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
10730return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
10731empty input.
10732
10733** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
10734for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
10735`iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
10736Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
10737`read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
10738
10739** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
10740echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
10741a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
10742default password to use if the user enters nothing.
10743
10744** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
10745specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
10746function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
10747place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
10748non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
10749
10750** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
10751If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
10752up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
10753end of the window, even if this requires computation.
10754
10755** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
10756which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
10757If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
10758
10759** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
10760holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
10761was directed to display this buffer.
10762
10763** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
10764with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
10765describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
10766other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
10767set-window-configuration.
10768
10769** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
10770window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
10771positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
10772windows and the choice of buffers to display.
10773
10774** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
10775override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
10776look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
10777
10778If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
10779non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
10780map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
10781
10782minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
10783and it is meant to be set by major modes.
10784
10785** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
10786except that it discards all text properties from the result.
10787
10788** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
10789USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
10790floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
10791
10792** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
10793to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
10794in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
10795it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
10796
10797** Menu changes
10798
10799*** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
10800keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
10801better supported.
10802
10803The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
10804a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
10805you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
10806can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
10807then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
10808
10809*** A new format for menu items is supported.
10810
10811In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
10812 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
10813defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
10814starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
10815
10816The format is:
10817 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
10818 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
10819where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
10820string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
10821The supported properties include
10822
10823:enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
10824 item is enabled.
10825:visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
10826 item should appear in the menu.
10827:filter FILTER-FN
10828 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
10829 which will be REAL-BINDING.
10830 It should return a binding to use instead.
10831:keys DESCRIPTION
10832 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
f3780fe4 10833 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
3787e12e
GM
10834 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
10835:key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
10836 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
10837 keyboard binding.
10838:key-sequence nil
10839 This means that the command normally has no
10840 keyboard equivalent.
10841:help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
10842:button (TYPE . SELECTED)
10843 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
10844 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
10845 value says whether this button is currently selected.
10846
10847Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
10848Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
10849
10850(menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
10851
10852** New event types
10853
10854*** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
10855mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
10856corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
10857which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
10858
10859 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
10860
10861where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
10862same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
10863indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
10864negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
10865the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
10866forward, away from the user.
10867
10868As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
10869
10870*** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
10871files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
10872and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
10873filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
10874loaded into Emacs. The format is:
10875
10876 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
10877
10878where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
10879same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
10880that were dragged and dropped.
10881
10882As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
10883
10884** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
10885
10886*** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
10887any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
10888to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
10889
10890*** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
10891can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
10892that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
10893
10894*** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
10895in Emacs 19 and before.
10896
10897The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
10898The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
10899
10900*** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
10901buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
10902unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
10903representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
10904
10905This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
10906as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
10907viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
10908one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
10909will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
10910
10911This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
10912representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
10913(including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
10914consistent with the new representation.
10915
10916*** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
10917representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
10918about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
10919however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
10920
10921The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
10922nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
10923using the table nonascii-translation-table.
10924
10925*** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
10926representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
10927representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
10928
10929The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
10930loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
10931is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
10932
10933*** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
10934which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
10935
10936*** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
10937which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
10938
10939*** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
10940portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
10941so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
10942You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
10943
10944*** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
10945it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
10946
10947*** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
10948convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
10949buffer or string being searched.
10950
10951One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
10952[...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
10953searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
10954searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
10955obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
10956you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
10957expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
10958
10959*** Structure of coding system changed.
10960
10961All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
10962by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
10963which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
10964as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
10965vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
10966your own alias name of a coding system by the function
10967define-coding-system-alias.
10968
10969The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
10970the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
10971access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
10972pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
10973character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
10974safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
10975'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
10976`iso-8859-1'.
10977
10978Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
10979The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
10980coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
10981(coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
10982
10983Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
10984also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
10985are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
10986the other character sets and read it back correctly.
10987
10988*** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
10989proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
10990This function requires a user interaction.
10991
10992*** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
10993find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
10994select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
10995systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
10996a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
10997select-safe-coding-system.
10998
10999*** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
11000decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
11001last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
11002was done.
11003
11004*** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
11005used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
11006coding systems used by some specific language environment.
11007
11008*** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
11009return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
11010characters are found, they now return a list of single element
11011`undecided' or its subsidiaries.
11012
11013*** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
11014coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
11015coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
11016converted.
11017
11018*** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
11019coding system for communicating with other X clients.
11020
11021*** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
11022character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
11023character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
11024each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
11025either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
11026range of characters.
11027
11028*** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
11029Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
11030
11031*** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
11032in the current buffer at position POS.
11033
11034*** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
11035input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
11036function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
11037character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
11038event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
11039binding input-method-function to nil.
11040
11041The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
11042method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
11043input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
11044the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
11045not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
11046
11047The input method function is not called when reading the second and
11048subsequent events of a key sequence.
11049
11050*** You can customize any language environment by using
11051set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
11052
11053The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
11054customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
11055instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
11056environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
11057exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
05197f40 11058\f
3787e12e
GM
11059* Changes in Emacs 20.1
11060
11061** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
11062options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
11063at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
11064tree structure.
11065
11066M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
11067user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
11068
11069With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
11070session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
11071in your .emacs file.)
11072
11073** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
11074You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
11075
11076** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
11077This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
11078
11079** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
11080immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
11081kills the region.
11082
11083The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
11084delete the character before point, as usual.
11085
11086** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
11087on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
11088by setting search-highlight to nil.)
11089
11090** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
11091insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
11092the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
11093onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
11094history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
11095past.)
11096
11097** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
11098This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
11099in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
11100TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
11101makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
11102
11103As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
11104and is an alias for it.
11105
11106If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
11107use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
11108
11109** Scrolling changes
11110
11111*** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
11112position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
11113
11114In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
11115on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
11116where it started.
11117
11118*** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
11119move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
11120screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
11121does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
11122
11123*** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
11124top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
11125comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
11126recenters the window.
11127
11128** International character set support (MULE)
11129
11130Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
11131including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
11132Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
11133Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
11134features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
11135MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
11136
11137Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
11138coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
11139character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
11140variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
11141into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
11142
11143Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
11144generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
11145supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
11146language, to make it possible to type them.
11147
11148The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
11149character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
11150
11151The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
11152to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
11153
11154You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
11155
11156 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
11157
11158Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
11159characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
11160argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
11161already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
11162characters for their work until they want to change.
11163
11164*** Input methods
11165
11166An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
11167specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
11168has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
11169the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
11170support several input methods.
11171
11172The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
11173another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
11174work.
11175
11176A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
11177characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
11178composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
11179consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
11180sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
11181letter.
11182
11183The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
11184by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
11185First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
11186marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
11187mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
11188
11189None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
11190they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
11191phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
11192converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
11193
11194Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
11195word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
11196typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
11197the first guess is wrong.
11198
11199*** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
11200turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
11201
11202If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
11203byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
11204they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
11205the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
11206
11207However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
11208use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
11209includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
11210translate automatically to and from either one.
11211
11212*** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
11213
11214Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
11215file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
11216sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
11217what you want.
11218
11219If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
11220example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
11221system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
11222multibyte characters in that buffer.
11223
11224If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
11225character conversion as well.
11226
11227*** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
11228
11229A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
11230Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
11231requires using many fonts.
11232
11233Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
11234collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
11235
11236A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
11237the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
11238have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
11239you would use a font.
11240
11241If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
11242specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
11243display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
11244
11245The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
11246(that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
f327c2f9 11247characters).
3787e12e
GM
11248
11249*** Defining fontsets.
11250
11251Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
11252chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
11253with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
11254
11255Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
11256of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
11257`fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
11258standard fontset are created automatically.
11259
11260If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
11261argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
11262FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
11263with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
11264name is `fontset-startup'.
11265
11266Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
11267The resource value should have this form:
11268 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
11269FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
11270 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
11271 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
11272 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
11273The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
11274of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
0969bd6a
EZ
11275CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
11276should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
3787e12e
GM
11277
11278Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
11279last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
11280You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
11281
11282For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
11283font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
11284following resource,
11285 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
11286the font for ASCII is generated as below:
11287 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
11288Here is the substitution rule:
11289 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
11290 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
11291 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
11292 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
11293 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
11294
11295The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
11296fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
11297that function explicitly to create a fontset.
11298
11299With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
11300like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
11301name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
11302fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
11303fontsets.
11304
11305*** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
11306defaults for a particular choice of language.
11307
11308Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
11309method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
11310visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
11311already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
11312language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
11313system for new files that you create.
11314
11315It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
11316set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
11317whole Emacs session.
11318
11319For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
11320chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
11321with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
11322
11323*** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
11324specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
11325specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
11326the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
11327coding systems that Emacs supports.
11328
11329*** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
11330lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
11331This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
11332After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
11333is used for *the immediately following command*.
11334
11335So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
11336write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
11337
11338If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
11339then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
11340
c3518b63 11341For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
3787e12e
GM
11342visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
11343
11344*** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
11345construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
11346to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
11347specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
11348of the file.
11349
11350*** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
11351the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
11352code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
11353translated into that character code.
11354
11355This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
11356various countries to support the languages of those countries.
11357
11358By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
11359
11360*** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
11361the coding system for keyboard input.
11362
11363Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
11364with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
11365some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
11366
11367By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
11368
11369Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
11370input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
11371translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
11372to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
11373designed to work with terminals.
11374
11375*** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
11376specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
11377This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
11378has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
11379translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
11380in the corresponding buffer.
11381
11382By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
11383
11384*** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
11385to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
11386It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
11387
11388*** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
11389an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
11390command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
11391want to use.
11392
11393C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
11394method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
11395
11396*** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
11397layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
11398remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
11399which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
11400
11401*** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
11402the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
11403related information.
11404
11405*** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
11406HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
11407scripts.
11408
11409*** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
11410information about the support for a particular language.
11411You specify the language as an argument.
11412
11413*** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
11414the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
11415first dash.
11416
11417A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
11418(except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
11419whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
114201 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
11421
11422 A alternativnyj (Russian)
11423 B big5 (Chinese)
11424 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
11425 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
11426 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
11427 E euc-japan (Japanese)
11428 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11429 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
11430 K euc-korea (Korean)
11431 R koi8 (Russian)
11432 Q tibetan
11433 S shift_jis (Japanese)
11434 T lao
11435 T tis620 (Thai)
11436 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
11437 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11438 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
11439 v viqr (Vietnamese)
11440 z hz (Chinese)
11441
11442When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
11443two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
11444coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
11445keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
11446
11447*** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
11448conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
11449
11450When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
11451into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
11452rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
11453Rmail files themselves.
11454
11455*** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
11456conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
11457
11458Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
11459for sending mail:
11460
11461- If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
11462- Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
11463- Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
11464 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
11465- Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
11466
11467*** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
11468to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
11469Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
11470translations.
11471
11472** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
11473of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
11474insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
11475without any conversion.
11476
11477** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
11478You can now specify any number of octal digits.
11479RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
11480any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
11481
11482** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
11483functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
11484
11485Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
11486Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
11487
11488Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
11489mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
11490
11491** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
11492complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
11493in the buffer before point.
11494
11495With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
11496symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
11497you are using.
11498
11499With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
11500just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
11501
11502** File locking works with NFS now.
11503
11504The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
11505in the same directory as FILENAME.
11506
11507This means that collision detection between two different machines now
11508works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
11509can become a bottleneck.
11510
11511The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
11512does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
11513create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
11514file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
11515rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
11516so useful that the change is worth while.
11517
11518When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
11519are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
11520collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
11521tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
11522
11523** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
11524it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
11525show-paren-mode.
11526
11527** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
11528selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
11529delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
11530
11531** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
11532within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
11533complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
11534
11535** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
11536it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
11537set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
11538
11539** Changes in View mode.
11540
11541*** Several new commands are available in View mode.
11542Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
11543
11544*** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
11545view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
11546
11547*** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
11548previous state.
11549
11550*** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
11551scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
11552
11553*** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
11554non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
11555not just the selected window.
11556
11557*** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
11558read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
11559turns View mode on or off.
11560
11561*** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
11562how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
11563delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
11564
11565** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
11566now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
11567
11568** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
11569has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
11570presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
11571which version to compare with.
11572
11573** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
11574blocks if a match is inside the block.
11575
11576The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
11577is outside the block. By customizing the variable
11578isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
11579shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
11580
11581By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
11582of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
11583blocks, all of them or none.
11584
11585** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
11586current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
11587confirmation first.
11588
11589** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
11590now changes the major mode according to that file name.
11591However, the mode will not be changed if
11592(1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
11593(2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
11594 not suitable for ordinary files, or
11595(3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
11596
11597This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
11598
11599However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
11600these commands do not change the major mode.
11601
11602** M-x occur changes.
11603
11604*** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
11605it performs a case-sensitive search.
11606
11607*** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
11608if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
11609using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
11610
11611** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
11612in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
11613window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
11614that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
11615buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
11616
11617** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
11618after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
11619appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
11620come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
11621
11622** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
11623selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
11624buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
11625
11626** Outline mode changes.
11627
11628*** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
11629
11630*** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
11631
11632** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
11633you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
11634Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
11635was already active.
11636
11637The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
11638unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
11639get confused by it.
11640
11641If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
11642set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
11643
11644** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
11645
11646*** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
11647conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
11648character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
11649including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
11650
11651The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
11652mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
11653copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
11654
11655*** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
11656are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
11657values.
11658
11659`dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
11660case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
11661`dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
11662case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
11663
11664** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
11665certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
11666can be. The default value is 30.
11667
11668** Changes in Mail mode.
11669
11670*** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
11671Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
11672composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
11673`mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
11674`sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
11675behavior.
11676
11677C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
11678compose-mail-other-frame.
11679
11680*** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
11681the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
11682replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
11683buffer that shows the original message.
11684
11685*** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
11686with separator lines around the contents.
11687
11688*** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
11689in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
11690definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
11691need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
11692
11693*** New features in the mail-complete command.
11694
11695**** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
11696for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
11697controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
11698Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
11699
11700**** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
11701to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
11702/etc/passwd.
11703
11704**** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
11705to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
11706/etc/passwd.
11707
11708** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
11709special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
11710directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
11711reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
11712
11713Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
11714when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
11715be taken to be magic.
11716
11717** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
11718files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
11719available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
11720
11721M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
11722(-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
11723
11724** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
11725suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
11726
11727In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
11728
11729new key dired.el binding old key
11730------- ---------------- -------
11731 * c dired-change-marks c
11732 * m dired-mark m
11733 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
11734 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
11735 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
11736 * u dired-unmark u
11737 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
3a426197 11738 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
3787e12e
GM
11739 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
11740 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
11741 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
11742 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
11743
11744** Rmail changes.
11745
11746*** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
11747saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
11748chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
11749each time you run it.
11750
11751*** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
11752whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
11753
11754*** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
11755messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
11756means to move in the opposite direction.
11757
11758*** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
11759you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
11760
11761*** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
11762just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
11763It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
11764can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
11765for output.
11766
11767** Gnus changes.
11768
11769*** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
11770
11771*** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
11772Gnus.
11773
11774*** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
11775`and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
11776
11777*** Article washing status can be displayed in the
11778article mode line.
11779
11780*** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
11781
11782*** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
11783
11784(setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
11785
11786*** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
11787are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
11788`gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
11789
11790*** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
11791
11792*** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
11793
11794*** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
11795See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
11796
11797*** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
11798Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
11799used to pick articles.
11800
11801*** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
11802another have been added.
11803
11804 `M-x gnus-change-server'
11805
11806*** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
11807generating lines in buffers.
11808
11809*** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
3a426197 11810`C-M-_'.
3787e12e
GM
11811
11812*** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
11813
11814*** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
11815
11816 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
11817
11818*** Scores can be decayed.
11819
11820 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
11821
11822*** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
11823Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
11824
11825*** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
11826the native server.
11827
11828 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
11829
11830*** A new command for reading collections of documents
3a426197 11831(nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
3787e12e
GM
11832
11833*** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
11834
11835*** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
11836even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
11837
11838*** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
11839(DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
11840
11841 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
11842 a group.
11843
11844*** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
11845sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
11846
11847 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
11848
11849*** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
11850
11851 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
11852
11853*** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
11854
11855 Use the `Y c' command.
11856
11857*** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
11858
11859*** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
11860
11861 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
11862
11863*** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
11864from incoming mail before saving the mail.
11865
11866 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
11867
11868*** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
11869
11870*** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
11871the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
11872
11873 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
11874
11875Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
11876and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
11877from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
11878hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
11879this issue.)
11880
11881Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
11882automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
11883particular news group. This can be done by:
11884
11885 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
11886
11887Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
11888of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
11889"XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
11890system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
11891for reading and posting).
11892
11893CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
11894 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
11895Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
11896newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
11897there.
11898
11899Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
11900default. Here are some of these default settings:
11901
11902 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
11903 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
11904 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
11905 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
11906 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
11907
11908When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
11909the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
11910
11911** CC mode changes.
11912
11913*** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
11914code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
11915values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
11916this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
11917Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
11918loaded.
11919
11920If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
11921Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
11922style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
11923share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
11924c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
11925must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
11926
11927*** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
11928of the current buffer.
11929
11930*** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
11931it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
11932of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
11933
11934*** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
11935style that the Python developers like.
11936
11937*** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
11938This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
11939just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
11940
11941** VC Changes [new]
11942
9614842d 11943*** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
3787e12e
GM
11944name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
11945directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
11946
11947This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
11948master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
11949developers.
11950
11951You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
11952RET in a buffer visiting that file.
11953
11954*** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
11955other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
11956writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
11957calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
11958
11959*** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
11960version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
11961
11962** Calendar changes.
11963
9614842d
JW
11964*** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
11965subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
11966you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
11967following/previous years.
11968
11969*** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
11970the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
11971calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
11972each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
11973calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
11974supposed attribute of God.
3787e12e
GM
11975
11976** ps-print changes
11977
2261f14e
GM
11978There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
11979layout.
3787e12e 11980
2261f14e 11981*** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
3787e12e 11982
2261f14e
GM
11983Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
11984be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
11985printer system has this behavior, set variable
11986`ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
3787e12e 11987
2261f14e
GM
11988If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
11989blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
a5d03456 11990very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
3787e12e 11991
2261f14e
GM
11992The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
11993setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
3787e12e 11994
2261f14e
GM
11995 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
11996 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
11997 printing for your printer.
3787e12e 11998
2261f14e
GM
11999 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
12000 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
3787e12e 12001
2261f14e
GM
12002 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
12003 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
3787e12e 12004
2261f14e
GM
12005The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
12006opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
12007`ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
12008bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
12009ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
12010This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
12011The default value is nil.
3787e12e 12012
2261f14e
GM
12013The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
12014properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
3787e12e 12015
2261f14e
GM
12016 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
12017 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
12018 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
12019 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
12020 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
12021 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
12022 color). The default is 0 ("black").
3787e12e 12023
2261f14e
GM
12024 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
12025 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
12026
12027 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
12028 The default is 0 ("black").
12029
12030 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
12031 The default is 0 ("black").
12032
12033 border-width Specify the border width.
12034 The default is 0.4.
12035
12036Any other property is ignored.
12037
12038Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
12039`ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
12040documentation).
12041
12042Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
12043`ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
12044`ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
12045`ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
12046`ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
12047controlling headers.
3787e12e 12048
2261f14e
GM
12049*** Color management (subgroup)
12050
12051If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
12052color.
12053
12054*** Face Management (subgroup)
3787e12e 12055
2261f14e
GM
12056If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
12057set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
12058background should be used. Valid values are:
12059
12060 t always use face background color.
12061 nil never use face background color.
12062 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
12063
12064*** N-up printing (subgroup)
12065
12066The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
12067sheet of paper.
12068
12069The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
12070between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
12071
12072If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
12073each page.
12074
12075The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
12076on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
12077`ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
12078
12079 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
12080 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
12081 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
3787e12e 12082
2261f14e
GM
12083 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
12084 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
12085 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
12086
12087 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
12088 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
12089 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
12090
12091 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
12092 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
12093 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
3787e12e 12094
2261f14e
GM
12095Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
12096
12097*** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
3787e12e 12098
2261f14e
GM
12099The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
12100RGB color.
12101
12102The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
12103continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
12104to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
12105
12106 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
12107 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12108 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12109 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12110 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12111 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
12112 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
12113 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
12114 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12115 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12116 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12117 10 + 10 +
12118 11 + 11 +
12119 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12120 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12121 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
12122 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
12123 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
12124 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12125 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12126 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12127 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
12128 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
12129 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
12130 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
12131 22 + 22 +
12132 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12133
12134Any other value is treated as `nil'.
12135
12136
12137*** Printer management (subgroup)
12138
12139The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
12140some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
12141`ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
12142utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
12143to "-P".
12144
12145The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
12146paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
12147non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
12148
12149The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
12150should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
12151do so.
12152
12153*** Page settings (subgroup)
12154
12155If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
12156error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
12157indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
12158instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
12159the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
12160by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
12161`setpagedevice'.
12162
12163The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
12164printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
12165`upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
12166
12167The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
12168it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
12169integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
12170specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
12171is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
12172its TO, are ignored.
12173
12174The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
12175pages. Valid values are:
12176
12177 nil print all pages.
12178
12179 `even-page' print only even pages.
12180
12181 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
12182
12183 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
12184 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12185 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
12186 print only the even sheet of paper.
12187
12188 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
12189 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12190 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
12191 only the odd sheet of paper.
12192
12193Any other value is treated as nil.
12194
12195If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
12196are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
12197`ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
12198
12199 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
12200
12201and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
12202`ps-n-up-printing', we get:
12203
12204`ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
12205 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12206 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
12207 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12208 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12209 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12210 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12211
12212`ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
12213 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12214 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
12215 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
12216 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
12217 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
12218 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
12219
12220*** Miscellany (subgroup)
12221
12222The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
12223messages should be sent.
12224
12225It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
12226front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
12227`ps-user-defined-prologue'.
12228
12229The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
12230
12231The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
12232points for line numbers.
12233
12234The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
12235numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
12236
12237The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
12238line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
12239to 2, the printing will look like:
12240
12241 1 one line
12242 one line
12243 3 one line
12244 one line
12245 5 one line
12246 one line
12247 ...
12248
12249Valid values are:
12250
12251integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
12252 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
12253 is used.
12254
12255`zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
12256 zebra stripe is to be printed.
12257
12258Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
12259
12260The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
12261the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
12262`ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
122633, the output will look like:
12264
12265 one line
12266 one line
12267 3 one line
12268 one line
12269 one line
12270 6 one line
12271 one line
12272 one line
12273 9 one line
12274 one line
12275 ...
12276
12277The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
12278where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
12279
12280The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
12281for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12282`ps-font-size').
12283
12284The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
12285in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12286`ps-font-size').
12287
12288The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
12289
12290The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
12291start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
3787e12e
GM
12292
12293** hideshow changes.
12294
12295*** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
12296C++, ; for lisp).
12297
12298*** Support for java-mode added.
12299
12300*** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
12301in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
12302
f3780fe4 12303*** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
3787e12e
GM
12304the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
12305way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
12306
12307*** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
12308robust and a lot faster.
12309
12310*** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
12311
12312*** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
12313to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
12314documentation for more details.
12315
12316** Changes in Enriched mode.
12317
12318*** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
12319filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
12320of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
12321use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
12322the next time unless the fill-column is different.
12323
12324*** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
12325distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
12326as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
12327as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
12328
12329** Font Lock mode
12330
12331*** Custom support
12332
12333The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
12334font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify the
12335faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new custom
12336group font-lock-highlighting-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in
12337your ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
12338consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
12339
12340You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
12341
12342*** Maximum decoration
12343
12344Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
12345default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
12346of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
12347supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
12348to get the old behavior.
12349
12350*** New support
12351
12352Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
12353
12354Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
12355support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
12356
12357*** Configurable support
12358
12359Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
12360additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
12361c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
12362java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
12363list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
12364of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
12365convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
12366
12367Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
12368way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
12369it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
12370
12371*** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
12372
12373You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
12374highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
12375for any mode.
12376
12377For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
12378
12379 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
12380
12381in your ~/.emacs.
12382
12383*** New faces
12384
12385Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
12386font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
12387distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
12388to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
12389
12390*** Changes to fast-lock support mode
12391
12392The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
12393cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
12394same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
12395
12396*** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
12397
12398The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
12399according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
12400the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
12401non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
12402refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
12403the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
dfd67a62 12404Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
3787e12e
GM
12405
12406This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
12407For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
12408this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
12409refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
12410containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
c7bd5d57 12411the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
3787e12e
GM
12412
12413As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
12414
12415Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
12416Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
12417Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
12418new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
12419
12420If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
12421settings.
12422
12423** Ada mode changes.
12424
12425*** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
12426If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
12427procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
12428you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
12429stubs.
12430
12431*** There are two new commands:
12432 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
12433 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
12434
12435The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
12436`ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
12437`ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
12438
12439*** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
12440is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
12441Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
12442
12443*** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
12444formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
12445places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
12446space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
12447
12448** Scheme mode changes.
12449
12450*** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
12451mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
12452for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
12453with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
12454have any effect.
12455
12456If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
12457still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
12458scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
12459variables as buffer-local variables.
12460
12461*** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
12462Use M-x dsssl-mode.
12463
12464** Changes to the emacsclient program
12465
12466*** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
12467USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
12468associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
12469can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
12470
12471*** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
12472it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
12473buffer in Emacs.
12474
12475*** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
12476use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
12477ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
12478option takes precedence.
12479
12480** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
12481constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
12482(in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
12483
12484** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
12485which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
12486the current defun.
12487
12488** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
12489following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
12490
12491** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
12492and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
12493necessary).
12494
12495** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
12496if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
12497these register values no longer become completely useless.
12498If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
12499asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
12500it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
12501
12502** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
12503example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
12504be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
12505you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
12506
12507You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
12508variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
12509file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
12510revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
12511only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
12512
12513** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
12514since it applies only to the current frame.
12515
12516** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
12517file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
12518and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
12519
12520This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
12521multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
12522variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
12523tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
12524instead of just the file you are editing.
12525
12526** RefTeX mode
12527
12528RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
12529and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
12530different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
12531multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
12532turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
12533
12534C-c ( reftex-label
12535 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
12536 knows which kind of label is needed.
12537
12538C-c ) reftex-reference
12539 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
12540 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
12541
12542C-c [ reftex-citation
12543 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
12544 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
12545
12546C-c & reftex-view-crossref
12547 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
12548
12549C-c = reftex-toc
12550 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
12551 can quickly jump to every section.
12552
12553Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
12554commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
12555Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
12556reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
12557C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
12558
12559** Changes in BibTeX mode.
12560
12561*** Info documentation is now available.
12562
12563*** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
12564both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
12565
12566*** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
12567bibtex-user-optional-fields.
12568
12569*** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
12570(use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
12571
12572*** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
12573entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
12574appropriate functions.
12575
12576*** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
3a426197 12577entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
3787e12e
GM
12578
12579*** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
12580been cleaned.
12581
12582*** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
12583bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
12584
12585*** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
12586shall be delimited.
12587
12588*** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
12589bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
12590bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
12591
12592*** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
12593field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
12594prefixed with `ALT'.
12595
12596*** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
12597bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
12598formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
12599documentation).
12600
12601*** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
12602documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
12603for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
12604
12605*** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
12606comma should be inserted at end of last field.
12607
12608*** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
12609alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
12610signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
12611
12612*** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
12613
12614*** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
12615
12616*** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
12617from alien sources.
12618
12619*** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
12620to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
12621crossref entries.
12622
12623*** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
12624region.
12625
12626*** Added support for imenu.
12627
12628*** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
12629of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
12630`compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
12631`next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
12632
12633*** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
12634from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
12635
12636** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
12637
12638** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
12639
12640** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
12641functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
12642Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
12643as an argument.
12644
12645When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
12646and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
12647
12648** browse-url changes
12649
12650*** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
12651Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
12652(browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
12653non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
12654customization variables.
12655
12656*** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
12657
12658*** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
12659lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
12660(e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
12661
12662** Changes in Ediff
12663
12664*** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
12665pops up the Info file for this command.
12666
12667*** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
12668the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
12669merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
12670directories).
12671
12672*** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
12673and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
12674files in the same directory.
12675
12676*** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
12677The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
12678related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
12679
12680** Changes in Viper
12681
12682*** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
12683*** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
12684 instead of vip-.
12685*** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
12686*** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
12687Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
12688*** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
12689*** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
12690*** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
12691color when Viper is in insert state.
12692*** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
12693Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
12694viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
12695
12696** Etags changes.
12697
12698*** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
12699default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
12700Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
12701variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
12702not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
12703
12704*** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
12705
12706*** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
12707constructs are tagged. Files are recognised by the extension .java.
12708
12709*** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
12710recognised by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
12711In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
12712
12713*** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
12714C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
12715recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
12716methods and protocols.
12717
12718*** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognised by the extension
12719.cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
12720column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
12721paragraph name.
12722
12723*** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
12724an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
12725at least M times and as many as N times.
12726
12727** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
12728in files has changed slightly.
12729
12730With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
12731time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
12732This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
12733with old time-stamp-format values.
12734
12735In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
12736(`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
12737This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
12738reasons.
12739
12740In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
12741natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
12742fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
12743(`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
12744time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
12745specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
12746
12747Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
12748case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
12749truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
12750
12751The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
12752being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
12753future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
12754recommended now will continue to work then.
12755
12756See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
12757details.
12758
12759** There are some additional major modes:
12760
12761dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
12762m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
12763meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
12764
12765** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
12766copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
12767into Emacs.
12768
12769** New Lisp packages include:
12770
12771*** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
12772
12773*** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
12774be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
12775
12776*** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
12777
12778*** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
12779in shell buffers.
12780
12781*** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
12782See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
12783and `elint-defun'.
12784
12785*** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
12786meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
12787ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
12788strings or comments.
12789
12790These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
12791abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
12792you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
12793insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
12794at these points.
12795
12796*** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
12797can visit them by short forms of their names.
12798
12799*** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
12800Emacs Lisp function at point.
12801
12802*** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
12803
12804*** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
12805switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
12806
12807*** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
12808
12809*** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
12810
12811*** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
12812
12813*** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
12814from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
12815
12816*** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
12817You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
12818inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
12819original place after inserting the copy.
12820
12821*** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
12822on the buffer.
12823
12824You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
12825velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
12826(with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
12827
12828Enable mouse-drag with:
12829 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
12830-or-
12831 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
12832
12833*** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
12834mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
12835
12836*** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
12837It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
12838
12839*** ogonek
12840
12841The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
12842Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
12843platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
12844TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
12845ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
12846prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
12847instance) and vice versa.
12848
12849To use this package load it using
12850 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
12851Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
12852 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
12853 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
12854The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
12855ways of customization in `.emacs'.
12856
12857*** Interface to ph.
12858
12859Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
12860
12861The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
12862services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
12863these servers.
12864
12865*** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
12866
12867*** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
12868You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
12869while the real cursor does not move.
12870
12871*** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
12872for visiting your favorite web sites.
12873
12874*** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
12875so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
12876
12877** movemail change
12878
12879Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
12880mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
12881supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
12882user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
12883
12884This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
05197f40 12885\f
3787e12e
GM
12886* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
12887
12888** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
12889
12890Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
12891end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
12892Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
12893file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
12894file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
12895
12896To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
12897C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
12898coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
12899specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
12900LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
12901save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
05197f40 12902\f
3787e12e
GM
12903* Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
12904
12905** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
12906Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
12907vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
12908Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
12909
12910** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
12911to start with w32- instead of win32-.
12912
12913In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
12914don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
12915"win".
12916
12917** Basic Lisp changes
12918
12919*** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
12920evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
12921
12922*** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
12923be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
12924or by the user.
12925
12926The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
12927
12928*** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
12929
12930(when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
12931(unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
12932
12933*** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
12934usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
12935its argument.
12936
12937*** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
12938
12939*** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
12940
12941*** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
12942
12943*** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
12944error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
12945include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
12946`format' function.
12947
12948*** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
12949or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
12950whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
12951
12952*** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
12953either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
12954adding one of these suffixes.
12955
12956*** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
12957which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
12958If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
12959
12960We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
12961because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
12962
12963*** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
12964
12965*** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
12966You must load the `cl' library to define it.
12967
12968*** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
12969conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
12970
12971 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
12972
12973BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
12974BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
12975
12976*** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
12977choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
12978restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
12979works using `save-current-buffer'.
12980
12981*** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
12982write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
12983of the last form.
12984
12985*** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
12986which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
12987last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
12988as the last form.
12989
12990*** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
12991characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
12992matches.
12993
12994For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
12995
12996*** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
12997with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
12998Then it returns that string.
12999
13000For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
13001
13002(with-output-to-string
13003 (princ "The buffer is ")
13004 (princ (buffer-name)))
13005
13006returns "The buffer is foo".
13007
13008** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
13009is non-nil.
13010
13011These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
13012buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
13013characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
13014
13015*** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
13016a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
13017
13018Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
13019character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
13020Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
13021position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
13022characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
13023 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
13024
13025ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
13026Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
13027non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
13028characters".
13029
13030The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
13031through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
13032"leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
13033range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
13034leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
13035
13036*** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
13037(forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
13038multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
13039character, which may be more than one buffer position.
13040
13041This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
13042always one buffer position, need to be changed.
13043
13044However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
13045
13046*** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
13047because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
13048have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
13049the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
13050guaranteed.
13051
13052*** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
13053between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
13054character).
13055
13056When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
13057
13058 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
13059 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
13060 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
13061 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
13062 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
13063
13064*** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
13065
13066*** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
13067`length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
13068more than the number of characters.
13069
13070You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
13071it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
13072\xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
13073is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
13074follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
13075newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
13076
13077*** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
13078and returns a string containing those characters.
13079
13080*** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
13081(sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
13082counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
13083character, sref signals an error.
13084
13085*** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
13086in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
13087string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13088
13089*** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
13090in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
13091region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13092
13093*** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
13094the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
13095to a vector of the characters in it.
13096
13097*** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
13098of a string. You call it as follows:
13099
13100 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
13101
13102This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
13103STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
13104This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
13105Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
13106it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
13107
13108*** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
13109if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13110
13111*** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
13112if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13113
13114*** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
13115to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
13116not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
13117which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
13118
13119(truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
13120
13121This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
13122
13123The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
13124If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
13125are not included in the resulting value.
13126
13127The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
13128at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
13129WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
13130is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
13131
13132If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
13133place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
13134character extends across that column), then the padding character
13135PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
13136string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
13137column START-COLUMN.
13138
13139*** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
13140the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
13141necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
13142difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
13143changed text, before the change.
13144
13145*** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
13146sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
13147one character set for each script, not for each language.
13148
13149**** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
13150
13151**** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
13152
13153**** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
13154set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
13155
13156**** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
13157name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
13158which identify the character within that character set.
13159
13160**** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
13161byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
13162opposite of split-char.
13163
13164**** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
13165of all the characters between BEG and END.
13166
13167**** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
13168of all the characters in a string.
13169
13170*** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
13171and specifying coding systems.
13172
13173**** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
13174system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
13175of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
13176(Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
13177and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
13178as what to do about code conversion.)
13179
13180**** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
13181name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
13182
13183**** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13184for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13185except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
13186
13187Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13188which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
13189to match against a file name.
13190
13191VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13192a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13193decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13194to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13195systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13196specifies the coding system for encoding.
13197
13198If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13199or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13200
13201**** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
13202the coding system to use for network sockets.
13203
13204Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13205which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
13206either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
13207service names.
13208
13209VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13210a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13211decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13212to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13213systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13214specifies the coding system for encoding.
13215
13216If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13217or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13218
13219**** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13220for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13221except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
13222start the subprocess.
13223
13224**** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
13225systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
13226when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
13227(OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
13228to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
13229
13230**** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
13231coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
13232subprocess.
13233
13234It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
13235but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
13236start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
13237connection permanently or until overridden.
13238
13239The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
13240file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
13241network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
13242coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
13243It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
13244system for one operation at a time.
13245
13246**** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
13247files, subprocesses or network connections.
13248
13249**** The function process-coding-system tells you what
13250coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
13251The value is a cons cell,
13252 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
13253where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
13254the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
13255input to the subprocess.
13256
13257**** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
13258change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
13259
13260** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
13261customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
13262you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
13263
13264You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
13265variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
13266information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
13267legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
13268customization.
13269
13270Thus, instead of writing
13271
13272 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
13273 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
13274
13275you would now write this:
13276
13277 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
13278 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
13279 :type 'boolean
13280 :group foo)
13281
13282The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
13283two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
13284describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
13285for a description of them.
13286
13287The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
13288should belong to. You define a new group like this:
13289
13290 (defgroup ispell nil
13291 "Spell checking using Ispell."
13292 :group 'processes)
13293
13294The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
13295group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
13296but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
13297to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
13298second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
13299
13300Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
13301package should have just one group; a more complex package should
13302have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
13303package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
13304first-level subgroups.
13305
13306** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
13307
13308This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
13309separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
13310
13311** easy-mmode
13312
13313The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
13314developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
13315only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
13316predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
13317`easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
13318`easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
13319
13320** Text property changes
13321
13322*** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
13323text property.
13324
13325*** The new functions next-char-property-change and
13326previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
13327place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
13328functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
13329starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
13330
13331If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
13332LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
13333of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
13334position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
13335
13336*** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
13337value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
13338is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
13339
13340** Changes in invisibility features
13341
13342*** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
13343hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
13344is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
13345should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
13346would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
13347make the overlay visible.
13348
13349During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
13350invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
13351needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
13352which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
13353the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
13354t when it should hide it.
13355
13356*** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
13357
13358Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
13359invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
13360and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
13361Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
13362manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
13363Here is an example of how to do this:
13364
13365 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
13366 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13367 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
13368 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13369
13370 ...
13371 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
13372
13373 ...
13374 ;; When done with the overlays:
13375 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13376 ;; Or respectively:
13377 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13378
13379** Changes in syntax parsing.
13380
13381*** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
13382`parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
13383obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
13384`parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
13385
13386If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
13387is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
13388used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
13389
13390When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
13391character in the buffer is calculated thus:
13392
13393 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
13394 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
13395
13396 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
13397 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
13398 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
13399
13400 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
13401 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
13402 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
13403 determine the syntax type of the character.
13404
13405 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
13406 of the current buffer.
13407
13408*** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
13409value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
13410for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
13411
13412*** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
13413and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
13414only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
13415character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
13416another character with the same code (unless quoted).
13417
13418These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
13419text property.
13420
13421*** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
13422arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
13423of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
13424
13425*** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
13426(and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
13427element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
13428nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
13429string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
13430
13431*** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
13432syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
13433`font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
13434
13435** Changes in face features
13436
13437*** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
13438if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
13439
13440*** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
13441of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
13442
13443*** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
13444set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
13445
13446*** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
13447set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
13448
13449*** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
13450by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
13451and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
13452the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
13453overlay property).
13454
13455This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
13456arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
13457
13458** Changes in file-handling functions
13459
13460*** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
13461directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
13462they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
13463is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
13464
13465This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
13466begins with ~.
13467
13468*** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
13469it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
13470
13471*** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
13472the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
13473
13474*** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
13475as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
13476
13477*** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
13478character code conversion as well as other things.
13479
13480Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
13481(formerly it did not).
13482
13483*** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
13484environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
13485
13486*** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
13487instead of constant strings.
13488
13489*** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
13490to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
13491any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
13492
13493substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
13494in the same way as before.
13495
13496*** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
13497The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
13498which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
13499
13500*** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
13501error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
13502else, and returns nil.
13503
13504*** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
13505directory cannot be listed.
13506
13507** Changes in minibuffer input
13508
13509*** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
13510read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
13511additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
13512argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
13513ways:
13514
13515 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
13516 It is available through the history command M-n.
13517
13518*** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
13519read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
13520argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
13521minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
13522enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
13523
13524In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
13525argument in this way.
13526
13527*** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
13528from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
13529minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
13530
13531** Echo area features
13532
13533*** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
13534echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
13535minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
13536after the echo area is cleared.
13537
13538*** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
13539in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
13540
13541** Keyboard input features
13542
13543*** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
13544set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
13545
13546*** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
13547received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
13548by keyboard macros.
13549
13550** Frame-related changes
13551
13552*** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
13553creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
13554hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
13555
13556*** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
13557the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
13558has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
13559
13560*** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
13561selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
13562value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
13563in the selected frame.
13564
13565*** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
13566is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
13567which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
13568
13569** X Windows features
13570
13571*** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
13572x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
13573x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
13574
13575*** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
13576The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
13577
13578*** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
13579MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
13580A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
13581
13582If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
13583it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
13584
13585** Subprocess features
13586
13587*** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
13588functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
13589automatically.
13590
13591*** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
13592and returns the output from the command as a string.
13593
13594*** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
13595and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
13596
13597** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
13598does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
13599
13600** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
13601at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
13602goes after the other menu items.
13603
13604** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
13605of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
13606around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
13607are in use.
13608
13609The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
13610series of several changes--if that seems safe.
13611
13612Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
13613after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
13614form.
13615
13616** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
13617is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
13618but its hook is still run.
13619
13620** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
13621for errors that are handled by condition-case.
13622
13623If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
13624regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
13625useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
13626
13627This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
13628are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
13629filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
13630warned.
13631
13632** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
13633way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
13634
13635** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
13636integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
13637functions like display-time.
13638
13639** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
13640name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
13641
13642** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
13643can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
13644is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
13645
13646** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
13647if there is an error in compilation.
13648
13649** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
13650switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
13651argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
13652they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
13653
13654** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
13655Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
13656the *scratch* buffer.
13657
13658** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
13659The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
13660where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
13661e.g., in Font Lock mode.
13662
13663** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
13664and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
13665It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
13666
13667** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
13668using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
13669variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
13670and compose-mail-other-frame.
13671
13672** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
13673can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
13674full name of the specified user will be returned.
13675
13676** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
13677of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
13678where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
13679in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
13680option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
13681files at all.
13682
13683** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
13684and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
13685width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
13686the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
13687
13688For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
13689minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
13690with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
13691is how %S normally pads to two positions.
13692
13693** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
13694
13695** imenu.el changes.
13696
13697You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
13698item from menu created by imenu.
13699
13700An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
13701#include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
13702select one of those items.
05197f40 13703\f
3787e12e 13704* For older news, see the file ONEWS
a933dad1
DL
13705
13706----------------------------------------------------------------------
13707Copyright information:
13708
175573ac 13709Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
a933dad1
DL
13710
13711 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
13712 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
13713 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
13714 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
13715
13716 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
13717 of this document, or of portions of it,
13718 under the above conditions, provided also that they
13719 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
05197f40 13720\f
a933dad1
DL
13721Local variables:
13722mode: outline
13723paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
13724end:
ab5796a9
MB
13725
13726arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793